]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/config/frv/frv.c
re PR c/43772 (Errant -Wlogical-op warning when testing limits)
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / config / frv / frv.c
CommitLineData
66647d44 1/* Copyright (C) 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
96e45421 2 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
36a05131
BS
3 Contributed by Red Hat, Inc.
4
7ec022b2 5This file is part of GCC.
36a05131 6
7ec022b2 7GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
36a05131 8it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
2f83c7d6 9the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
36a05131
BS
10any later version.
11
7ec022b2 12GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
36a05131
BS
13but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
2f83c7d6
NC
18along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
19<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
36a05131
BS
20
21#include "config.h"
22#include "system.h"
4977bab6
ZW
23#include "coretypes.h"
24#include "tm.h"
36a05131
BS
25#include "rtl.h"
26#include "tree.h"
27#include "regs.h"
28#include "hard-reg-set.h"
36a05131
BS
29#include "insn-config.h"
30#include "conditions.h"
31#include "insn-flags.h"
32#include "output.h"
33#include "insn-attr.h"
34#include "flags.h"
35#include "recog.h"
36#include "reload.h"
37#include "expr.h"
38#include "obstack.h"
39#include "except.h"
40#include "function.h"
41#include "optabs.h"
718f9c0f 42#include "diagnostic-core.h"
36a05131
BS
43#include "basic-block.h"
44#include "tm_p.h"
45#include "ggc.h"
36a05131
BS
46#include "target.h"
47#include "target-def.h"
8cd5a4e0 48#include "targhooks.h"
34208acf 49#include "integrate.h"
6e34d3a3 50#include "langhooks.h"
6fb5fa3c 51#include "df.h"
36a05131
BS
52
53#ifndef FRV_INLINE
54#define FRV_INLINE inline
55#endif
56
c557edf4
RS
57/* The maximum number of distinct NOP patterns. There are three:
58 nop, fnop and mnop. */
59#define NUM_NOP_PATTERNS 3
60
61/* Classification of instructions and units: integer, floating-point/media,
62 branch and control. */
63enum frv_insn_group { GROUP_I, GROUP_FM, GROUP_B, GROUP_C, NUM_GROUPS };
64
65/* The DFA names of the units, in packet order. */
66static const char *const frv_unit_names[] =
67{
68 "c",
69 "i0", "f0",
70 "i1", "f1",
71 "i2", "f2",
72 "i3", "f3",
73 "b0", "b1"
74};
75
76/* The classification of each unit in frv_unit_names[]. */
77static const enum frv_insn_group frv_unit_groups[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names)] =
78{
79 GROUP_C,
80 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
81 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
82 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
83 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
84 GROUP_B, GROUP_B
85};
86
87/* Return the DFA unit code associated with the Nth unit of integer
88 or floating-point group GROUP, */
89#define NTH_UNIT(GROUP, N) frv_unit_codes[(GROUP) + (N) * 2 + 1]
90
91/* Return the number of integer or floating-point unit UNIT
92 (1 for I1, 2 for F2, etc.). */
93#define UNIT_NUMBER(UNIT) (((UNIT) - 1) / 2)
94
95/* The DFA unit number for each unit in frv_unit_names[]. */
96static int frv_unit_codes[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names)];
97
98/* FRV_TYPE_TO_UNIT[T] is the last unit in frv_unit_names[] that can issue
99 an instruction of type T. The value is ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names) if
100 no instruction of type T has been seen. */
101static unsigned int frv_type_to_unit[TYPE_UNKNOWN + 1];
102
103/* An array of dummy nop INSNs, one for each type of nop that the
104 target supports. */
105static GTY(()) rtx frv_nops[NUM_NOP_PATTERNS];
106
107/* The number of nop instructions in frv_nops[]. */
108static unsigned int frv_num_nops;
109
5c5e8419
JR
110 /* The type of access. FRV_IO_UNKNOWN means the access can be either
111 a read or a write. */
112enum frv_io_type { FRV_IO_UNKNOWN, FRV_IO_READ, FRV_IO_WRITE };
113
38c28a25
AH
114/* Information about one __builtin_read or __builtin_write access, or
115 the combination of several such accesses. The most general value
116 is all-zeros (an unknown access to an unknown address). */
117struct frv_io {
5c5e8419 118 enum frv_io_type type;
38c28a25
AH
119
120 /* The constant address being accessed, or zero if not known. */
121 HOST_WIDE_INT const_address;
122
123 /* The run-time address, as used in operand 0 of the membar pattern. */
124 rtx var_address;
125};
126
c557edf4
RS
127/* Return true if instruction INSN should be packed with the following
128 instruction. */
129#define PACKING_FLAG_P(INSN) (GET_MODE (INSN) == TImode)
130
131/* Set the value of PACKING_FLAG_P(INSN). */
132#define SET_PACKING_FLAG(INSN) PUT_MODE (INSN, TImode)
133#define CLEAR_PACKING_FLAG(INSN) PUT_MODE (INSN, VOIDmode)
134
135/* Loop with REG set to each hard register in rtx X. */
136#define FOR_EACH_REGNO(REG, X) \
137 for (REG = REGNO (X); \
138 REG < REGNO (X) + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (X), GET_MODE (X)); \
139 REG++)
140
38c28a25 141/* This structure contains machine specific function data. */
d1b38208 142struct GTY(()) machine_function
38c28a25
AH
143{
144 /* True if we have created an rtx that relies on the stack frame. */
145 int frame_needed;
146
147 /* True if this function contains at least one __builtin_{read,write}*. */
148 bool has_membar_p;
149};
150
36a05131
BS
151/* Temporary register allocation support structure. */
152typedef struct frv_tmp_reg_struct
153 {
154 HARD_REG_SET regs; /* possible registers to allocate */
155 int next_reg[N_REG_CLASSES]; /* next register to allocate per class */
156 }
157frv_tmp_reg_t;
158
c557edf4 159/* Register state information for VLIW re-packing phase. */
36a05131 160#define REGSTATE_CC_MASK 0x07 /* Mask to isolate CCn for cond exec */
c557edf4
RS
161#define REGSTATE_MODIFIED 0x08 /* reg modified in current VLIW insn */
162#define REGSTATE_IF_TRUE 0x10 /* reg modified in cond exec true */
163#define REGSTATE_IF_FALSE 0x20 /* reg modified in cond exec false */
164
36a05131
BS
165#define REGSTATE_IF_EITHER (REGSTATE_IF_TRUE | REGSTATE_IF_FALSE)
166
c557edf4 167typedef unsigned char regstate_t;
36a05131
BS
168
169/* Used in frv_frame_accessor_t to indicate the direction of a register-to-
170 memory move. */
171enum frv_stack_op
172{
173 FRV_LOAD,
174 FRV_STORE
175};
176
177/* Information required by frv_frame_access. */
178typedef struct
179{
180 /* This field is FRV_LOAD if registers are to be loaded from the stack and
181 FRV_STORE if they should be stored onto the stack. FRV_STORE implies
182 the move is being done by the prologue code while FRV_LOAD implies it
183 is being done by the epilogue. */
184 enum frv_stack_op op;
185
186 /* The base register to use when accessing the stack. This may be the
187 frame pointer, stack pointer, or a temporary. The choice of register
188 depends on which part of the frame is being accessed and how big the
189 frame is. */
190 rtx base;
191
192 /* The offset of BASE from the bottom of the current frame, in bytes. */
193 int base_offset;
194} frv_frame_accessor_t;
195
87b483a1 196/* Conditional execution support gathered together in one structure. */
36a05131
BS
197typedef struct
198 {
199 /* Linked list of insns to add if the conditional execution conversion was
200 successful. Each link points to an EXPR_LIST which points to the pattern
201 of the insn to add, and the insn to be inserted before. */
202 rtx added_insns_list;
203
204 /* Identify which registers are safe to allocate for if conversions to
205 conditional execution. We keep the last allocated register in the
206 register classes between COND_EXEC statements. This will mean we allocate
207 different registers for each different COND_EXEC group if we can. This
208 might allow the scheduler to intermix two different COND_EXEC sections. */
209 frv_tmp_reg_t tmp_reg;
210
211 /* For nested IFs, identify which CC registers are used outside of setting
212 via a compare isnsn, and using via a check insn. This will allow us to
213 know if we can rewrite the register to use a different register that will
214 be paired with the CR register controlling the nested IF-THEN blocks. */
215 HARD_REG_SET nested_cc_ok_rewrite;
216
217 /* Temporary registers allocated to hold constants during conditional
218 execution. */
219 rtx scratch_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
220
221 /* Current number of temp registers available. */
222 int cur_scratch_regs;
223
87b483a1 224 /* Number of nested conditional execution blocks. */
36a05131
BS
225 int num_nested_cond_exec;
226
227 /* Map of insns that set up constants in scratch registers. */
228 bitmap scratch_insns_bitmap;
229
87b483a1 230 /* Conditional execution test register (CC0..CC7). */
36a05131
BS
231 rtx cr_reg;
232
233 /* Conditional execution compare register that is paired with cr_reg, so that
234 nested compares can be done. The csubcc and caddcc instructions don't
235 have enough bits to specify both a CC register to be set and a CR register
236 to do the test on, so the same bit number is used for both. Needless to
839a4992 237 say, this is rather inconvenient for GCC. */
36a05131
BS
238 rtx nested_cc_reg;
239
240 /* Extra CR registers used for &&, ||. */
241 rtx extra_int_cr;
242 rtx extra_fp_cr;
243
244 /* Previous CR used in nested if, to make sure we are dealing with the same
87b483a1 245 nested if as the previous statement. */
36a05131
BS
246 rtx last_nested_if_cr;
247 }
248frv_ifcvt_t;
249
250static /* GTY(()) */ frv_ifcvt_t frv_ifcvt;
251
252/* Map register number to smallest register class. */
253enum reg_class regno_reg_class[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
254
87b483a1 255/* Cached value of frv_stack_info. */
36a05131
BS
256static frv_stack_t *frv_stack_cache = (frv_stack_t *)0;
257
36a05131 258/* Forward references */
0b2c18fe 259
c5387660 260static void frv_option_override (void);
c6c3dba9 261static bool frv_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode, rtx, bool);
f2206911 262static int frv_default_flags_for_cpu (void);
3101faab 263static int frv_string_begins_with (const_tree, const char *);
34208acf 264static FRV_INLINE bool frv_small_data_reloc_p (rtx, int);
0fb30cb7
NF
265static void frv_print_operand (FILE *, rtx, int);
266static void frv_print_operand_address (FILE *, rtx);
267static bool frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code);
36a05131 268static void frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg
f2206911
KC
269 (FILE *, rtx);
270static void frv_print_operand_memory_reference (FILE *, rtx, int);
271static int frv_print_operand_jump_hint (rtx);
036ff63f 272static const char *comparison_string (enum rtx_code, rtx);
219d92a4
AS
273static rtx frv_function_value (const_tree, const_tree,
274 bool);
275static rtx frv_libcall_value (enum machine_mode,
276 const_rtx);
f2206911
KC
277static FRV_INLINE int frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (int, int);
278static rtx single_set_pattern (rtx);
279static int frv_function_contains_far_jump (void);
280static rtx frv_alloc_temp_reg (frv_tmp_reg_t *,
281 enum reg_class,
282 enum machine_mode,
283 int, int);
284static rtx frv_frame_offset_rtx (int);
285static rtx frv_frame_mem (enum machine_mode, rtx, int);
286static rtx frv_dwarf_store (rtx, int);
287static void frv_frame_insn (rtx, rtx);
288static void frv_frame_access (frv_frame_accessor_t*,
289 rtx, int);
290static void frv_frame_access_multi (frv_frame_accessor_t*,
291 frv_stack_t *, int);
292static void frv_frame_access_standard_regs (enum frv_stack_op,
293 frv_stack_t *);
294static struct machine_function *frv_init_machine_status (void);
f2206911
KC
295static rtx frv_int_to_acc (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
296static enum machine_mode frv_matching_accg_mode (enum machine_mode);
2396bce1
EC
297static rtx frv_read_argument (tree, unsigned int);
298static rtx frv_read_iacc_argument (enum machine_mode, tree, unsigned int);
f2206911
KC
299static int frv_check_constant_argument (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
300static rtx frv_legitimize_target (enum insn_code, rtx);
301static rtx frv_legitimize_argument (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
bef8809e 302static rtx frv_legitimize_tls_address (rtx, enum tls_model);
506d7b68 303static rtx frv_legitimize_address (rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode);
f2206911
KC
304static rtx frv_expand_set_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
305static rtx frv_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
306static rtx frv_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
307static rtx frv_expand_cut_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
308static rtx frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
309static rtx frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
c557edf4
RS
310static rtx frv_expand_int_void2arg (enum insn_code, tree);
311static rtx frv_expand_prefetches (enum insn_code, tree);
f2206911
KC
312static rtx frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
313static rtx frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
314static rtx frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (tree);
315static rtx frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
316static rtx frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
317static rtx frv_expand_noargs_builtin (enum insn_code);
c557edf4 318static void frv_split_iacc_move (rtx, rtx);
f2206911
KC
319static rtx frv_emit_comparison (enum rtx_code, rtx, rtx);
320static int frv_clear_registers_used (rtx *, void *);
321static void frv_ifcvt_add_insn (rtx, rtx, int);
322static rtx frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx);
323static rtx frv_ifcvt_load_value (rtx, rtx);
c557edf4
RS
324static int frv_acc_group_1 (rtx *, void *);
325static unsigned int frv_insn_unit (rtx);
326static bool frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (rtx);
327static int frv_cond_flags (rtx);
328static bool frv_regstate_conflict_p (regstate_t, regstate_t);
329static int frv_registers_conflict_p_1 (rtx *, void *);
330static bool frv_registers_conflict_p (rtx);
7bc980e1 331static void frv_registers_update_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
c557edf4
RS
332static void frv_registers_update (rtx);
333static void frv_start_packet (void);
334static void frv_start_packet_block (void);
335static void frv_finish_packet (void (*) (void));
336static bool frv_pack_insn_p (rtx);
337static void frv_add_insn_to_packet (rtx);
338static void frv_insert_nop_in_packet (rtx);
339static bool frv_for_each_packet (void (*) (void));
340static bool frv_sort_insn_group_1 (enum frv_insn_group,
341 unsigned int, unsigned int,
342 unsigned int, unsigned int,
343 state_t);
344static int frv_compare_insns (const void *, const void *);
345static void frv_sort_insn_group (enum frv_insn_group);
346static void frv_reorder_packet (void);
347static void frv_fill_unused_units (enum frv_insn_group);
348static void frv_align_label (void);
349static void frv_reorg_packet (void);
350static void frv_register_nop (rtx);
351static void frv_reorg (void);
f2206911
KC
352static void frv_pack_insns (void);
353static void frv_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
354static void frv_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
355static bool frv_assemble_integer (rtx, unsigned, int);
356static void frv_init_builtins (void);
357static rtx frv_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
358static void frv_init_libfuncs (void);
3101faab 359static bool frv_in_small_data_p (const_tree);
3961e8fe 360static void frv_asm_output_mi_thunk
f2206911 361 (FILE *, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, tree);
d5cc9181 362static void frv_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t,
d8c2bed3
KH
363 enum machine_mode,
364 tree, int *, int);
8ac411c7 365static rtx frv_expand_builtin_saveregs (void);
d7bd8aeb 366static void frv_expand_builtin_va_start (tree, rtx);
68f932c4
RS
367static bool frv_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int, int*,
368 bool);
33124e84
AS
369static int frv_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode,
370 reg_class_t, reg_class_t);
371static int frv_memory_move_cost (enum machine_mode,
372 reg_class_t, bool);
f2206911
KC
373static void frv_asm_out_constructor (rtx, int);
374static void frv_asm_out_destructor (rtx, int);
34208acf 375static bool frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (rtx);
1a627b35 376static bool frv_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode, rtx);
fbbf66e7 377static bool frv_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode, rtx);
34208acf
AO
378static const char *unspec_got_name (int);
379static void frv_output_const_unspec (FILE *,
380 const struct frv_unspec *);
764678d1 381static bool frv_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree);
8ac411c7 382static rtx frv_struct_value_rtx (tree, int);
586de218 383static bool frv_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type);
d5cc9181 384static int frv_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
78a52f11 385 tree, bool);
d5cc9181 386static rtx frv_function_arg (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
88a1f47f 387 const_tree, bool);
d5cc9181 388static rtx frv_function_incoming_arg (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
88a1f47f 389 const_tree, bool);
d5cc9181 390static void frv_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
88a1f47f 391 const_tree, bool);
c2ed6cf8
NF
392static unsigned int frv_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode,
393 const_tree);
fdbe66f2
EB
394static void frv_output_dwarf_dtprel (FILE *, int, rtx)
395 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
a87cf97e 396static reg_class_t frv_secondary_reload (bool, rtx, reg_class_t,
35f2d8ef
NC
397 enum machine_mode,
398 secondary_reload_info *);
b52b1749 399static bool frv_frame_pointer_required (void);
7b5cbb57 400static bool frv_can_eliminate (const int, const int);
5efd84c5 401static void frv_conditional_register_usage (void);
e9d5fdb2 402static void frv_trampoline_init (rtx, tree, rtx);
c28350ab 403static bool frv_class_likely_spilled_p (reg_class_t);
0b2c18fe 404\f
36a05131 405/* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
0fb30cb7
NF
406#undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND
407#define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND frv_print_operand
408#undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
409#define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS frv_print_operand_address
410#undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
411#define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p
36a05131
BS
412#undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
413#define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE frv_function_prologue
414#undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
415#define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE frv_function_epilogue
416#undef TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
417#define TARGET_ASM_INTEGER frv_assemble_integer
c5387660
JM
418#undef TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
419#define TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE frv_option_override
14966b94
KG
420#undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
421#define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS frv_init_builtins
422#undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
423#define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN frv_expand_builtin
c15c90bb
ZW
424#undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
425#define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS frv_init_libfuncs
b3fbfc07
KG
426#undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
427#define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P frv_in_small_data_p
33124e84
AS
428#undef TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
429#define TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST frv_register_move_cost
430#undef TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
431#define TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST frv_memory_move_cost
3c50106f
RH
432#undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
433#define TARGET_RTX_COSTS frv_rtx_costs
90a63880
RH
434#undef TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
435#define TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR frv_asm_out_constructor
436#undef TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
437#define TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR frv_asm_out_destructor
36a05131 438
c590b625
RH
439#undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
440#define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK frv_asm_output_mi_thunk
3961e8fe
RH
441#undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
442#define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK default_can_output_mi_thunk_no_vcall
c590b625 443
28a60850
RS
444#undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
445#define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE frv_issue_rate
ffb344c1 446
506d7b68
PB
447#undef TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
448#define TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS frv_legitimize_address
449
764678d1
AO
450#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
451#define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL frv_function_ok_for_sibcall
1a627b35
RS
452#undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
453#define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P frv_legitimate_constant_p
34208acf
AO
454#undef TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
455#define TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM frv_cannot_force_const_mem
456
bef8809e
AH
457#undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS
458#define TARGET_HAVE_TLS HAVE_AS_TLS
459
8ac411c7
KH
460#undef TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
461#define TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX frv_struct_value_rtx
fe984136
RH
462#undef TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
463#define TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK frv_must_pass_in_stack
8cd5a4e0
RH
464#undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
465#define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE hook_pass_by_reference_must_pass_in_stack
78a52f11
RH
466#undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
467#define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES frv_arg_partial_bytes
88a1f47f
NF
468#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
469#define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG frv_function_arg
470#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
471#define TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG frv_function_incoming_arg
472#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
473#define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE frv_function_arg_advance
c2ed6cf8
NF
474#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
475#define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY frv_function_arg_boundary
8ac411c7
KH
476
477#undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
478#define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS frv_expand_builtin_saveregs
d8c2bed3
KH
479#undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
480#define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS frv_setup_incoming_varargs
c557edf4
RS
481#undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
482#define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG frv_reorg
8ac411c7 483
d7bd8aeb
JJ
484#undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START
485#define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START frv_expand_builtin_va_start
486
fdbe66f2
EB
487#if HAVE_AS_TLS
488#undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
489#define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL frv_output_dwarf_dtprel
490#endif
491
c28350ab
AS
492#undef TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
493#define TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P frv_class_likely_spilled_p
494
35f2d8ef
NC
495#undef TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
496#define TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD frv_secondary_reload
497
c6c3dba9
PB
498#undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
499#define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P frv_legitimate_address_p
500
b52b1749
AS
501#undef TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
502#define TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED frv_frame_pointer_required
503
7b5cbb57
AS
504#undef TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
505#define TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE frv_can_eliminate
506
5efd84c5
NF
507#undef TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
508#define TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE frv_conditional_register_usage
509
e9d5fdb2
RH
510#undef TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
511#define TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT frv_trampoline_init
512
219d92a4
AS
513#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
514#define TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE frv_function_value
515#undef TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
516#define TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE frv_libcall_value
517
36a05131 518struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
bef8809e
AH
519
520#define FRV_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P(RTX) \
521 (GET_CODE (RTX) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (RTX) != 0)
522
36a05131 523\f
764678d1
AO
524/* Any function call that satisfies the machine-independent
525 requirements is eligible on FR-V. */
526
527static bool
528frv_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
529 tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
530{
531 return true;
532}
533
34208acf
AO
534/* Return true if SYMBOL is a small data symbol and relocation RELOC
535 can be used to access it directly in a load or store. */
36a05131 536
34208acf
AO
537static FRV_INLINE bool
538frv_small_data_reloc_p (rtx symbol, int reloc)
36a05131 539{
34208acf
AO
540 return (GET_CODE (symbol) == SYMBOL_REF
541 && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (symbol)
542 && (!TARGET_FDPIC || flag_pic == 1)
543 && (reloc == R_FRV_GOTOFF12 || reloc == R_FRV_GPREL12));
544}
36a05131 545
34208acf
AO
546/* Return true if X is a valid relocation unspec. If it is, fill in UNSPEC
547 appropriately. */
36a05131 548
6d26dc3b 549bool
34208acf
AO
550frv_const_unspec_p (rtx x, struct frv_unspec *unspec)
551{
552 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
553 {
554 unspec->offset = 0;
555 x = XEXP (x, 0);
556 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
557 {
558 unspec->offset += INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
559 x = XEXP (x, 0);
560 }
561 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_GOT)
562 {
563 unspec->symbol = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
564 unspec->reloc = INTVAL (XVECEXP (x, 0, 1));
36a05131 565
34208acf
AO
566 if (unspec->offset == 0)
567 return true;
36a05131 568
34208acf
AO
569 if (frv_small_data_reloc_p (unspec->symbol, unspec->reloc)
570 && unspec->offset > 0
fa37ed29 571 && unspec->offset < g_switch_value)
34208acf
AO
572 return true;
573 }
574 }
575 return false;
36a05131
BS
576}
577
34208acf
AO
578/* Decide whether we can force certain constants to memory. If we
579 decide we can't, the caller should be able to cope with it in
580 another way.
36a05131 581
34208acf
AO
582 We never allow constants to be forced into memory for TARGET_FDPIC.
583 This is necessary for several reasons:
36a05131 584
1a627b35 585 1. Since frv_legitimate_constant_p rejects constant pool addresses, the
34208acf
AO
586 target-independent code will try to force them into the constant
587 pool, thus leading to infinite recursion.
36a05131 588
34208acf
AO
589 2. We can never introduce new constant pool references during reload.
590 Any such reference would require use of the pseudo FDPIC register.
36a05131 591
34208acf
AO
592 3. We can't represent a constant added to a function pointer (which is
593 not the same as a pointer to a function+constant).
594
595 4. In many cases, it's more efficient to calculate the constant in-line. */
596
597static bool
fbbf66e7
RS
598frv_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
599 rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
34208acf
AO
600{
601 return TARGET_FDPIC;
602}
36a05131
BS
603\f
604static int
f2206911 605frv_default_flags_for_cpu (void)
36a05131
BS
606{
607 switch (frv_cpu_type)
608 {
609 case FRV_CPU_GENERIC:
610 return MASK_DEFAULT_FRV;
611
c557edf4
RS
612 case FRV_CPU_FR550:
613 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR550;
614
36a05131
BS
615 case FRV_CPU_FR500:
616 case FRV_CPU_TOMCAT:
617 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR500;
618
c557edf4
RS
619 case FRV_CPU_FR450:
620 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR450;
621
622 case FRV_CPU_FR405:
36a05131
BS
623 case FRV_CPU_FR400:
624 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR400;
625
626 case FRV_CPU_FR300:
627 case FRV_CPU_SIMPLE:
628 return MASK_DEFAULT_SIMPLE;
44e91694
NS
629
630 default:
631 gcc_unreachable ();
36a05131 632 }
36a05131
BS
633}
634
c5387660 635/* Implement TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE. */
36a05131 636
c5387660
JM
637static void
638frv_option_override (void)
36a05131 639{
c557edf4
RS
640 int regno;
641 unsigned int i;
36a05131 642
36a05131
BS
643 target_flags |= (frv_default_flags_for_cpu () & ~target_flags_explicit);
644
645 /* -mlibrary-pic sets -fPIC and -G0 and also suppresses warnings from the
646 linker about linking pic and non-pic code. */
647 if (TARGET_LIBPIC)
648 {
649 if (!flag_pic) /* -fPIC */
650 flag_pic = 2;
651
fa37ed29 652 if (!global_options_set.x_g_switch_value) /* -G0 */
36a05131 653 {
36a05131
BS
654 g_switch_value = 0;
655 }
656 }
657
36a05131
BS
658 /* A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard
659 register REGNO. In general there is more than one such class;
660 choose a class which is "minimal", meaning that no smaller class
87b483a1 661 also contains the register. */
36a05131
BS
662
663 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
664 {
0a2aaacc 665 enum reg_class rclass;
36a05131
BS
666
667 if (GPR_P (regno))
668 {
669 int gpr_reg = regno - GPR_FIRST;
bef8809e
AH
670
671 if (gpr_reg == GR8_REG)
0a2aaacc 672 rclass = GR8_REGS;
bef8809e
AH
673
674 else if (gpr_reg == GR9_REG)
0a2aaacc 675 rclass = GR9_REGS;
bef8809e
AH
676
677 else if (gpr_reg == GR14_REG)
0a2aaacc 678 rclass = FDPIC_FPTR_REGS;
bef8809e
AH
679
680 else if (gpr_reg == FDPIC_REGNO)
0a2aaacc 681 rclass = FDPIC_REGS;
bef8809e
AH
682
683 else if ((gpr_reg & 3) == 0)
0a2aaacc 684 rclass = QUAD_REGS;
36a05131
BS
685
686 else if ((gpr_reg & 1) == 0)
0a2aaacc 687 rclass = EVEN_REGS;
36a05131
BS
688
689 else
0a2aaacc 690 rclass = GPR_REGS;
36a05131
BS
691 }
692
693 else if (FPR_P (regno))
694 {
695 int fpr_reg = regno - GPR_FIRST;
696 if ((fpr_reg & 3) == 0)
0a2aaacc 697 rclass = QUAD_FPR_REGS;
36a05131
BS
698
699 else if ((fpr_reg & 1) == 0)
0a2aaacc 700 rclass = FEVEN_REGS;
36a05131
BS
701
702 else
0a2aaacc 703 rclass = FPR_REGS;
36a05131
BS
704 }
705
706 else if (regno == LR_REGNO)
0a2aaacc 707 rclass = LR_REG;
36a05131
BS
708
709 else if (regno == LCR_REGNO)
0a2aaacc 710 rclass = LCR_REG;
36a05131
BS
711
712 else if (ICC_P (regno))
0a2aaacc 713 rclass = ICC_REGS;
36a05131
BS
714
715 else if (FCC_P (regno))
0a2aaacc 716 rclass = FCC_REGS;
36a05131
BS
717
718 else if (ICR_P (regno))
0a2aaacc 719 rclass = ICR_REGS;
36a05131
BS
720
721 else if (FCR_P (regno))
0a2aaacc 722 rclass = FCR_REGS;
36a05131
BS
723
724 else if (ACC_P (regno))
725 {
726 int r = regno - ACC_FIRST;
727 if ((r & 3) == 0)
0a2aaacc 728 rclass = QUAD_ACC_REGS;
36a05131 729 else if ((r & 1) == 0)
0a2aaacc 730 rclass = EVEN_ACC_REGS;
36a05131 731 else
0a2aaacc 732 rclass = ACC_REGS;
36a05131
BS
733 }
734
735 else if (ACCG_P (regno))
0a2aaacc 736 rclass = ACCG_REGS;
36a05131
BS
737
738 else
0a2aaacc 739 rclass = NO_REGS;
36a05131 740
0a2aaacc 741 regno_reg_class[regno] = rclass;
36a05131
BS
742 }
743
744 /* Check for small data option */
fa37ed29 745 if (!global_options_set.x_g_switch_value && !TARGET_LIBPIC)
36a05131
BS
746 g_switch_value = SDATA_DEFAULT_SIZE;
747
36a05131
BS
748 /* There is no single unaligned SI op for PIC code. Sometimes we
749 need to use ".4byte" and sometimes we need to use ".picptr".
750 See frv_assemble_integer for details. */
34208acf 751 if (flag_pic || TARGET_FDPIC)
36a05131
BS
752 targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.si = 0;
753
34208acf
AO
754 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_LINKED_FP) == 0)
755 target_flags |= MASK_LINKED_FP;
756
38c28a25
AH
757 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR) == 0)
758 target_flags |= MASK_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR;
759
c557edf4
RS
760 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names); i++)
761 frv_unit_codes[i] = get_cpu_unit_code (frv_unit_names[i]);
762
763 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_type_to_unit); i++)
764 frv_type_to_unit[i] = ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes);
765
36a05131
BS
766 init_machine_status = frv_init_machine_status;
767}
768
36a05131
BS
769\f
770/* Return true if NAME (a STRING_CST node) begins with PREFIX. */
771
772static int
3101faab 773frv_string_begins_with (const_tree name, const char *prefix)
36a05131 774{
3101faab 775 const int prefix_len = strlen (prefix);
36a05131
BS
776
777 /* Remember: NAME's length includes the null terminator. */
778 return (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (name) > prefix_len
779 && strncmp (TREE_STRING_POINTER (name), prefix, prefix_len) == 0);
780}
36a05131
BS
781\f
782/* Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify two variables
783 `fixed_regs' and `call_used_regs' (both of type `char []') after they have
784 been initialized from the two preceding macros.
785
786 This is necessary in case the fixed or call-clobbered registers depend on
787 target flags.
788
789 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
790
791 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target flags,
792 you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify `fixed_regs' and
793 `call_used_regs' to 1 for each of the registers in the classes which should
794 not be used by GCC. Also define the macro `REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER' to return
795 `NO_REGS' if it is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
796
797 (However, if this class is not included in `GENERAL_REGS' and all of the
798 insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are controlled by target
799 switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using these registers when the
800 target switches are opposed to them.) */
801
5efd84c5 802static void
f2206911 803frv_conditional_register_usage (void)
36a05131
BS
804{
805 int i;
806
807 for (i = GPR_FIRST + NUM_GPRS; i <= GPR_LAST; i++)
808 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
809
810 for (i = FPR_FIRST + NUM_FPRS; i <= FPR_LAST; i++)
811 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
812
36a05131
BS
813 /* Reserve the registers used for conditional execution. At present, we need
814 1 ICC and 1 ICR register. */
815 fixed_regs[ICC_TEMP] = call_used_regs[ICC_TEMP] = 1;
816 fixed_regs[ICR_TEMP] = call_used_regs[ICR_TEMP] = 1;
817
818 if (TARGET_FIXED_CC)
819 {
820 fixed_regs[ICC_FIRST] = call_used_regs[ICC_FIRST] = 1;
821 fixed_regs[FCC_FIRST] = call_used_regs[FCC_FIRST] = 1;
822 fixed_regs[ICR_FIRST] = call_used_regs[ICR_FIRST] = 1;
823 fixed_regs[FCR_FIRST] = call_used_regs[FCR_FIRST] = 1;
824 }
825
34208acf
AO
826 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
827 fixed_regs[GPR_FIRST + 16] = fixed_regs[GPR_FIRST + 17] =
828 call_used_regs[GPR_FIRST + 16] = call_used_regs[GPR_FIRST + 17] = 0;
829
36a05131
BS
830#if 0
831 /* If -fpic, SDA_BASE_REG is the PIC register. */
832 if (g_switch_value == 0 && !flag_pic)
833 fixed_regs[SDA_BASE_REG] = call_used_regs[SDA_BASE_REG] = 0;
834
835 if (!flag_pic)
836 fixed_regs[PIC_REGNO] = call_used_regs[PIC_REGNO] = 0;
837#endif
838}
839
840\f
841/*
842 * Compute the stack frame layout
843 *
844 * Register setup:
845 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
846 * |Register |type |caller-save/callee-save|
847 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
848 * |GR0 |Zero register | - |
849 * |GR1 |Stack pointer(SP) | - |
850 * |GR2 |Frame pointer(FP) | - |
851 * |GR3 |Hidden parameter | caller save |
852 * |GR4-GR7 | - | caller save |
853 * |GR8-GR13 |Argument register | caller save |
854 * |GR14-GR15 | - | caller save |
855 * |GR16-GR31 | - | callee save |
856 * |GR32-GR47 | - | caller save |
857 * |GR48-GR63 | - | callee save |
858 * |FR0-FR15 | - | caller save |
859 * |FR16-FR31 | - | callee save |
860 * |FR32-FR47 | - | caller save |
861 * |FR48-FR63 | - | callee save |
862 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
863 *
864 * Stack frame setup:
865 * Low
866 * SP-> |-----------------------------------|
867 * | Argument area |
868 * |-----------------------------------|
869 * | Register save area |
870 * |-----------------------------------|
871 * | Local variable save area |
872 * FP-> |-----------------------------------|
873 * | Old FP |
874 * |-----------------------------------|
875 * | Hidden parameter save area |
876 * |-----------------------------------|
877 * | Return address(LR) storage area |
878 * |-----------------------------------|
879 * | Padding for alignment |
880 * |-----------------------------------|
881 * | Register argument area |
882 * OLD SP-> |-----------------------------------|
883 * | Parameter area |
884 * |-----------------------------------|
885 * High
886 *
887 * Argument area/Parameter area:
888 *
889 * When a function is called, this area is used for argument transfer. When
890 * the argument is set up by the caller function, this area is referred to as
891 * the argument area. When the argument is referenced by the callee function,
892 * this area is referred to as the parameter area. The area is allocated when
893 * all arguments cannot be placed on the argument register at the time of
894 * argument transfer.
895 *
896 * Register save area:
897 *
898 * This is a register save area that must be guaranteed for the caller
899 * function. This area is not secured when the register save operation is not
900 * needed.
901 *
902 * Local variable save area:
903 *
904 * This is the area for local variables and temporary variables.
905 *
906 * Old FP:
907 *
908 * This area stores the FP value of the caller function.
909 *
910 * Hidden parameter save area:
911 *
912 * This area stores the start address of the return value storage
913 * area for a struct/union return function.
914 * When a struct/union is used as the return value, the caller
915 * function stores the return value storage area start address in
916 * register GR3 and passes it to the caller function.
917 * The callee function interprets the address stored in the GR3
918 * as the return value storage area start address.
919 * When register GR3 needs to be saved into memory, the callee
920 * function saves it in the hidden parameter save area. This
921 * area is not secured when the save operation is not needed.
922 *
923 * Return address(LR) storage area:
924 *
925 * This area saves the LR. The LR stores the address of a return to the caller
926 * function for the purpose of function calling.
927 *
928 * Argument register area:
929 *
930 * This area saves the argument register. This area is not secured when the
931 * save operation is not needed.
932 *
933 * Argument:
934 *
935 * Arguments, the count of which equals the count of argument registers (6
936 * words), are positioned in registers GR8 to GR13 and delivered to the callee
937 * function. When a struct/union return function is called, the return value
938 * area address is stored in register GR3. Arguments not placed in the
939 * argument registers will be stored in the stack argument area for transfer
940 * purposes. When an 8-byte type argument is to be delivered using registers,
941 * it is divided into two and placed in two registers for transfer. When
942 * argument registers must be saved to memory, the callee function secures an
943 * argument register save area in the stack. In this case, a continuous
944 * argument register save area must be established in the parameter area. The
945 * argument register save area must be allocated as needed to cover the size of
946 * the argument register to be saved. If the function has a variable count of
947 * arguments, it saves all argument registers in the argument register save
948 * area.
949 *
950 * Argument Extension Format:
951 *
952 * When an argument is to be stored in the stack, its type is converted to an
953 * extended type in accordance with the individual argument type. The argument
954 * is freed by the caller function after the return from the callee function is
955 * made.
956 *
957 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
958 * | Argument Type |Extended Type |Stack Storage Size(byte)|
959 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
960 * |char |int | 4 |
961 * |signed char |int | 4 |
962 * |unsigned char |int | 4 |
963 * |[signed] short int |int | 4 |
964 * |unsigned short int |int | 4 |
965 * |[signed] int |No extension | 4 |
966 * |unsigned int |No extension | 4 |
967 * |[signed] long int |No extension | 4 |
968 * |unsigned long int |No extension | 4 |
969 * |[signed] long long int |No extension | 8 |
970 * |unsigned long long int |No extension | 8 |
971 * |float |double | 8 |
972 * |double |No extension | 8 |
973 * |long double |No extension | 8 |
974 * |pointer |No extension | 4 |
975 * |struct/union |- | 4 (*1) |
976 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
977 *
978 * When a struct/union is to be delivered as an argument, the caller copies it
979 * to the local variable area and delivers the address of that area.
980 *
981 * Return Value:
982 *
983 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
984 * |Return Value Type |Return Value Interface|
985 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
986 * |void |None |
987 * |[signed|unsigned] char |GR8 |
988 * |[signed|unsigned] short int |GR8 |
989 * |[signed|unsigned] int |GR8 |
990 * |[signed|unsigned] long int |GR8 |
991 * |pointer |GR8 |
992 * |[signed|unsigned] long long int|GR8 & GR9 |
993 * |float |GR8 |
994 * |double |GR8 & GR9 |
995 * |long double |GR8 & GR9 |
996 * |struct/union |(*1) |
997 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
998 *
999 * When a struct/union is used as the return value, the caller function stores
1000 * the start address of the return value storage area into GR3 and then passes
1001 * it to the callee function. The callee function interprets GR3 as the start
1002 * address of the return value storage area. When this address needs to be
1003 * saved in memory, the callee function secures the hidden parameter save area
1004 * and saves the address in that area.
1005 */
1006
1007frv_stack_t *
f2206911 1008frv_stack_info (void)
36a05131
BS
1009{
1010 static frv_stack_t info, zero_info;
1011 frv_stack_t *info_ptr = &info;
1012 tree fndecl = current_function_decl;
1013 int varargs_p = 0;
1014 tree cur_arg;
1015 tree next_arg;
1016 int range;
1017 int alignment;
1018 int offset;
1019
87b483a1
KH
1020 /* If we've already calculated the values and reload is complete,
1021 just return now. */
36a05131
BS
1022 if (frv_stack_cache)
1023 return frv_stack_cache;
1024
87b483a1 1025 /* Zero all fields. */
36a05131
BS
1026 info = zero_info;
1027
87b483a1 1028 /* Set up the register range information. */
36a05131
BS
1029 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].name = "gpr";
1030 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].first = LAST_ARG_REGNUM + 1;
1031 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].last = GPR_LAST;
1032 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].dword_p = TRUE;
1033
1034 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].name = "fpr";
1035 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].first = FPR_FIRST;
1036 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].last = FPR_LAST;
1037 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].dword_p = TRUE;
1038
1039 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].name = "lr";
1040 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].first = LR_REGNO;
1041 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].last = LR_REGNO;
1042 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].special_p = 1;
1043
1044 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].name = "cc";
1045 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].first = CC_FIRST;
1046 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].last = CC_LAST;
1047 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].field_p = TRUE;
1048
1049 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].name = "lcr";
1050 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].first = LCR_REGNO;
1051 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].last = LCR_REGNO;
1052
1053 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].name = "stdarg";
1054 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].first = FIRST_ARG_REGNUM;
1055 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].last = LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
1056 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].dword_p = 1;
1057 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].special_p = 1;
1058
1059 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].name = "struct";
8ac411c7
KH
1060 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].first = FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM;
1061 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].last = FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM;
36a05131
BS
1062 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].special_p = 1;
1063
1064 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].name = "fp";
1065 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].first = FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1066 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].last = FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1067 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].special_p = 1;
1068
1069 /* Determine if this is a stdarg function. If so, allocate space to store
1070 the 6 arguments. */
1071 if (cfun->stdarg)
1072 varargs_p = 1;
1073
1074 else
1075 {
1076 /* Find the last argument, and see if it is __builtin_va_alist. */
1077 for (cur_arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl); cur_arg != (tree)0; cur_arg = next_arg)
1078 {
910ad8de 1079 next_arg = DECL_CHAIN (cur_arg);
36a05131
BS
1080 if (next_arg == (tree)0)
1081 {
1082 if (DECL_NAME (cur_arg)
1083 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (cur_arg)), "__builtin_va_alist"))
1084 varargs_p = 1;
1085
1086 break;
1087 }
1088 }
1089 }
1090
87b483a1 1091 /* Iterate over all of the register ranges. */
36a05131
BS
1092 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1093 {
1094 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1095 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1096 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1097 int size_1word = 0;
1098 int size_2words = 0;
1099 int regno;
1100
87b483a1 1101 /* Calculate which registers need to be saved & save area size. */
36a05131
BS
1102 switch (range)
1103 {
1104 default:
1105 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1106 {
6fb5fa3c 1107 if ((df_regs_ever_live_p (regno) && !call_used_regs[regno])
e3b5732b 1108 || (crtl->calls_eh_return
36a05131 1109 && (regno >= FIRST_EH_REGNUM && regno <= LAST_EH_REGNUM))
34208acf 1110 || (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic
ad516a74 1111 && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table && regno == PIC_REGNO))
36a05131
BS
1112 {
1113 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1114 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1115 }
1116 }
1117 break;
1118
1119 /* Calculate whether we need to create a frame after everything else
1120 has been processed. */
1121 case STACK_REGS_FP:
1122 break;
1123
1124 case STACK_REGS_LR:
6fb5fa3c 1125 if (df_regs_ever_live_p (LR_REGNO)
36a05131 1126 || profile_flag
34208acf
AO
1127 /* This is set for __builtin_return_address, etc. */
1128 || cfun->machine->frame_needed
1129 || (TARGET_LINKED_FP && frame_pointer_needed)
1130 || (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic
ad516a74 1131 && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table))
36a05131
BS
1132 {
1133 info_ptr->save_p[LR_REGNO] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1134 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1135 }
1136 break;
1137
1138 case STACK_REGS_STDARG:
1139 if (varargs_p)
1140 {
87b483a1
KH
1141 /* If this is a stdarg function with a non varardic
1142 argument split between registers and the stack,
1143 adjust the saved registers downward. */
7dd68986 1144 last -= (ADDR_ALIGN (crtl->args.pretend_args_size, UNITS_PER_WORD)
36a05131
BS
1145 / UNITS_PER_WORD);
1146
1147 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1148 {
1149 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1150 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1151 }
1152
1153 info_ptr->stdarg_size = size_1word;
1154 }
1155 break;
1156
1157 case STACK_REGS_STRUCT:
1158 if (cfun->returns_struct)
1159 {
8ac411c7 1160 info_ptr->save_p[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
36a05131
BS
1161 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1162 }
1163 break;
1164 }
1165
1166
1167 if (size_1word)
1168 {
87b483a1 1169 /* If this is a field, it only takes one word. */
36a05131
BS
1170 if (reg_ptr->field_p)
1171 size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1172
87b483a1 1173 /* Determine which register pairs can be saved together. */
36a05131
BS
1174 else if (reg_ptr->dword_p && TARGET_DWORD)
1175 {
1176 for (regno = first; regno < last; regno += 2)
1177 {
1178 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] && info_ptr->save_p[regno+1])
1179 {
1180 size_2words += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1181 size_1word -= 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1182 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_2WORDS;
1183 info_ptr->save_p[regno+1] = REG_SAVE_NO_SAVE;
1184 }
1185 }
1186 }
1187
1188 reg_ptr->size_1word = size_1word;
1189 reg_ptr->size_2words = size_2words;
1190
1191 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1192 {
1193 info_ptr->regs_size_1word += size_1word;
1194 info_ptr->regs_size_2words += size_2words;
1195 }
1196 }
1197 }
1198
1199 /* Set up the sizes of each each field in the frame body, making the sizes
1200 of each be divisible by the size of a dword if dword operations might
1201 be used, or the size of a word otherwise. */
1202 alignment = (TARGET_DWORD? 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD : UNITS_PER_WORD);
1203
7dd68986 1204 info_ptr->parameter_size = ADDR_ALIGN (crtl->outgoing_args_size, alignment);
36a05131
BS
1205 info_ptr->regs_size = ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->regs_size_2words
1206 + info_ptr->regs_size_1word,
1207 alignment);
1208 info_ptr->vars_size = ADDR_ALIGN (get_frame_size (), alignment);
1209
7dd68986 1210 info_ptr->pretend_size = crtl->args.pretend_args_size;
36a05131
BS
1211
1212 /* Work out the size of the frame, excluding the header. Both the frame
1213 body and register parameter area will be dword-aligned. */
1214 info_ptr->total_size
1215 = (ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->parameter_size
1216 + info_ptr->regs_size
1217 + info_ptr->vars_size,
1218 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD)
1219 + ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->pretend_size
1220 + info_ptr->stdarg_size,
1221 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD));
1222
1223 /* See if we need to create a frame at all, if so add header area. */
1224 if (info_ptr->total_size > 0
34208acf 1225 || frame_pointer_needed
36a05131
BS
1226 || info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].size_1word > 0
1227 || info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].size_1word > 0)
1228 {
1229 offset = info_ptr->parameter_size;
1230 info_ptr->header_size = 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1231 info_ptr->total_size += 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1232
87b483a1 1233 /* Calculate the offsets to save normal register pairs. */
36a05131
BS
1234 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1235 {
1236 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1237 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1238 {
1239 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1240 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1241 int regno;
1242
1243 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1244 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS
1245 && regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1246 && (regno < FIRST_ARG_REGNUM
1247 || regno > LAST_ARG_REGNUM))
1248 {
1249 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1250 offset += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1251 }
1252 }
1253 }
1254
87b483a1 1255 /* Calculate the offsets to save normal single registers. */
36a05131
BS
1256 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1257 {
1258 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1259 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1260 {
1261 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1262 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1263 int regno;
1264
1265 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1266 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD
1267 && regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1268 && (regno < FIRST_ARG_REGNUM
1269 || regno > LAST_ARG_REGNUM))
1270 {
1271 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1272 offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1273 }
1274 }
1275 }
1276
1277 /* Calculate the offset to save the local variables at. */
1278 offset = ADDR_ALIGN (offset, alignment);
1279 if (info_ptr->vars_size)
1280 {
1281 info_ptr->vars_offset = offset;
1282 offset += info_ptr->vars_size;
1283 }
1284
1285 /* Align header to a dword-boundary. */
1286 offset = ADDR_ALIGN (offset, 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD);
1287
1288 /* Calculate the offsets in the fixed frame. */
1289 info_ptr->save_p[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1290 info_ptr->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM] = offset;
1291 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1292
1293 info_ptr->save_p[LR_REGNO] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1294 info_ptr->reg_offset[LR_REGNO] = offset + 2*UNITS_PER_WORD;
1295 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1296
1297 if (cfun->returns_struct)
1298 {
8ac411c7
KH
1299 info_ptr->save_p[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1300 info_ptr->reg_offset[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = offset + UNITS_PER_WORD;
36a05131
BS
1301 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Calculate the offsets to store the arguments passed in registers
1305 for stdarg functions. The register pairs are first and the single
1306 register if any is last. The register save area starts on a
1307 dword-boundary. */
1308 if (info_ptr->stdarg_size)
1309 {
1310 int first = info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].first;
1311 int last = info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].last;
1312 int regno;
1313
1314 /* Skip the header. */
1315 offset += 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1316 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1317 {
1318 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS)
1319 {
1320 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1321 offset += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1322 }
1323 else if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD)
1324 {
1325 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1326 offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1327 }
1328 }
1329 }
1330 }
1331
1332 if (reload_completed)
1333 frv_stack_cache = info_ptr;
1334
1335 return info_ptr;
1336}
1337
1338\f
87b483a1 1339/* Print the information about the frv stack offsets, etc. when debugging. */
36a05131
BS
1340
1341void
f2206911 1342frv_debug_stack (frv_stack_t *info)
36a05131
BS
1343{
1344 int range;
1345
1346 if (!info)
1347 info = frv_stack_info ();
1348
1349 fprintf (stderr, "\nStack information for function %s:\n",
1350 ((current_function_decl && DECL_NAME (current_function_decl))
1351 ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (current_function_decl))
1352 : "<unknown>"));
1353
1354 fprintf (stderr, "\ttotal_size\t= %6d\n", info->total_size);
1355 fprintf (stderr, "\tvars_size\t= %6d\n", info->vars_size);
1356 fprintf (stderr, "\tparam_size\t= %6d\n", info->parameter_size);
1357 fprintf (stderr, "\tregs_size\t= %6d, 1w = %3d, 2w = %3d\n",
1358 info->regs_size, info->regs_size_1word, info->regs_size_2words);
1359
1360 fprintf (stderr, "\theader_size\t= %6d\n", info->header_size);
1361 fprintf (stderr, "\tpretend_size\t= %6d\n", info->pretend_size);
1362 fprintf (stderr, "\tvars_offset\t= %6d\n", info->vars_offset);
1363 fprintf (stderr, "\tregs_offset\t= %6d\n", info->regs_offset);
1364
1365 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1366 {
1367 frv_stack_regs_t *regs = &(info->regs[range]);
1368 if ((regs->size_1word + regs->size_2words) > 0)
1369 {
1370 int first = regs->first;
1371 int last = regs->last;
1372 int regno;
1373
1374 fprintf (stderr, "\t%s\tsize\t= %6d, 1w = %3d, 2w = %3d, save =",
1375 regs->name, regs->size_1word + regs->size_2words,
1376 regs->size_1word, regs->size_2words);
1377
1378 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1379 {
1380 if (info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD)
1381 fprintf (stderr, " %s (%d)", reg_names[regno],
1382 info->reg_offset[regno]);
1383
1384 else if (info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS)
1385 fprintf (stderr, " %s-%s (%d)", reg_names[regno],
1386 reg_names[regno+1], info->reg_offset[regno]);
1387 }
1388
1389 fputc ('\n', stderr);
1390 }
1391 }
1392
1393 fflush (stderr);
1394}
1395
1396
1397\f
1398
c557edf4
RS
1399/* Used during final to control the packing of insns. The value is
1400 1 if the current instruction should be packed with the next one,
1401 0 if it shouldn't or -1 if packing is disabled altogether. */
36a05131
BS
1402
1403static int frv_insn_packing_flag;
1404
1405/* True if the current function contains a far jump. */
1406
1407static int
f2206911 1408frv_function_contains_far_jump (void)
36a05131
BS
1409{
1410 rtx insn = get_insns ();
1411 while (insn != NULL
1412 && !(GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
1413 /* Ignore tablejump patterns. */
1414 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_VEC
1415 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_DIFF_VEC
1416 && get_attr_far_jump (insn) == FAR_JUMP_YES))
1417 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1418 return (insn != NULL);
1419}
1420
1421/* For the FRV, this function makes sure that a function with far jumps
1422 will return correctly. It also does the VLIW packing. */
1423
1424static void
f2206911 1425frv_function_prologue (FILE *file, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131 1426{
0fad9ab9
NC
1427 rtx insn, next, last_call;
1428
36a05131
BS
1429 /* If no frame was created, check whether the function uses a call
1430 instruction to implement a far jump. If so, save the link in gr3 and
1431 replace all returns to LR with returns to GR3. GR3 is used because it
1432 is call-clobbered, because is not available to the register allocator,
1433 and because all functions that take a hidden argument pointer will have
1434 a stack frame. */
1435 if (frv_stack_info ()->total_size == 0 && frv_function_contains_far_jump ())
1436 {
1437 rtx insn;
1438
1439 /* Just to check that the above comment is true. */
6fb5fa3c 1440 gcc_assert (!df_regs_ever_live_p (GPR_FIRST + 3));
36a05131
BS
1441
1442 /* Generate the instruction that saves the link register. */
1443 fprintf (file, "\tmovsg lr,gr3\n");
1444
1445 /* Replace the LR with GR3 in *return_internal patterns. The insn
1446 will now return using jmpl @(gr3,0) rather than bralr. We cannot
1447 simply emit a different assembly directive because bralr and jmpl
1448 execute in different units. */
1449 for (insn = get_insns(); insn != NULL; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1450 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
1451 {
1452 rtx pattern = PATTERN (insn);
1453 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL
1454 && XVECLEN (pattern, 0) >= 2
1455 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0)) == RETURN
1456 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1)) == USE)
1457 {
1458 rtx address = XEXP (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1), 0);
1459 if (GET_CODE (address) == REG && REGNO (address) == LR_REGNO)
6fb5fa3c 1460 SET_REGNO (address, GPR_FIRST + 3);
36a05131
BS
1461 }
1462 }
1463 }
1464
1465 frv_pack_insns ();
c557edf4
RS
1466
1467 /* Allow the garbage collector to free the nops created by frv_reorg. */
1468 memset (frv_nops, 0, sizeof (frv_nops));
0fad9ab9
NC
1469
1470 /* Locate CALL_ARG_LOCATION notes that have been misplaced
1471 and move them back to where they should be located. */
1472 last_call = NULL_RTX;
1473 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = next)
1474 {
1475 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1476 if (CALL_P (insn)
1477 || (INSN_P (insn) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE
1478 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0))))
1479 last_call = insn;
1480
1481 if (!NOTE_P (insn) || NOTE_KIND (insn) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION)
1482 continue;
1483
1484 if (NEXT_INSN (last_call) == insn)
1485 continue;
1486
1487 NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1488 PREV_INSN (NEXT_INSN (insn)) = PREV_INSN (insn);
1489 PREV_INSN (insn) = last_call;
1490 NEXT_INSN (insn) = NEXT_INSN (last_call);
1491 PREV_INSN (NEXT_INSN (insn)) = insn;
1492 NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) = insn;
1493 last_call = insn;
1494 }
36a05131
BS
1495}
1496
1497\f
1498/* Return the next available temporary register in a given class. */
1499
1500static rtx
f2206911
KC
1501frv_alloc_temp_reg (
1502 frv_tmp_reg_t *info, /* which registers are available */
0a2aaacc 1503 enum reg_class rclass, /* register class desired */
f2206911
KC
1504 enum machine_mode mode, /* mode to allocate register with */
1505 int mark_as_used, /* register not available after allocation */
1506 int no_abort) /* return NULL instead of aborting */
36a05131 1507{
0a2aaacc 1508 int regno = info->next_reg[ (int)rclass ];
36a05131 1509 int orig_regno = regno;
0a2aaacc 1510 HARD_REG_SET *reg_in_class = &reg_class_contents[ (int)rclass ];
36a05131
BS
1511 int i, nr;
1512
1513 for (;;)
1514 {
1515 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*reg_in_class, regno)
1516 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (info->regs, regno))
1517 break;
1518
1519 if (++regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1520 regno = 0;
1521 if (regno == orig_regno)
1522 {
44e91694
NS
1523 gcc_assert (no_abort);
1524 return NULL_RTX;
36a05131
BS
1525 }
1526 }
1527
1528 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
0a2aaacc 1529 info->next_reg[ (int)rclass ] = regno + nr;
36a05131
BS
1530
1531 if (mark_as_used)
1532 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
1533 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (info->regs, regno+i);
1534
1535 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
1536}
1537
1538\f
1539/* Return an rtx with the value OFFSET, which will either be a register or a
1540 signed 12-bit integer. It can be used as the second operand in an "add"
1541 instruction, or as the index in a load or store.
1542
1543 The function returns a constant rtx if OFFSET is small enough, otherwise
1544 it loads the constant into register OFFSET_REGNO and returns that. */
1545static rtx
f2206911 1546frv_frame_offset_rtx (int offset)
36a05131
BS
1547{
1548 rtx offset_rtx = GEN_INT (offset);
2f5b1308 1549 if (IN_RANGE (offset, -2048, 2047))
36a05131
BS
1550 return offset_rtx;
1551 else
1552 {
1553 rtx reg_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, OFFSET_REGNO);
2f5b1308 1554 if (IN_RANGE (offset, -32768, 32767))
36a05131
BS
1555 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1556 else
1557 {
1558 emit_insn (gen_movsi_high (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1559 emit_insn (gen_movsi_lo_sum (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1560 }
1561 return reg_rtx;
1562 }
1563}
1564
1565/* Generate (mem:MODE (plus:Pmode BASE (frv_frame_offset OFFSET)))). The
1566 prologue and epilogue uses such expressions to access the stack. */
1567static rtx
f2206911 1568frv_frame_mem (enum machine_mode mode, rtx base, int offset)
36a05131
BS
1569{
1570 return gen_rtx_MEM (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
1571 base,
1572 frv_frame_offset_rtx (offset)));
1573}
1574
1575/* Generate a frame-related expression:
1576
1577 (set REG (mem (plus (sp) (const_int OFFSET)))).
1578
1579 Such expressions are used in FRAME_RELATED_EXPR notes for more complex
1580 instructions. Marking the expressions as frame-related is superfluous if
1581 the note contains just a single set. But if the note contains a PARALLEL
1582 or SEQUENCE that has several sets, each set must be individually marked
1583 as frame-related. */
1584static rtx
f2206911 1585frv_dwarf_store (rtx reg, int offset)
36a05131
BS
1586{
1587 rtx set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
1588 gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (reg),
1589 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
1590 offset)),
1591 reg);
1592 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (set) = 1;
1593 return set;
1594}
1595
1596/* Emit a frame-related instruction whose pattern is PATTERN. The
1597 instruction is the last in a sequence that cumulatively performs the
1598 operation described by DWARF_PATTERN. The instruction is marked as
1599 frame-related and has a REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR note containing
1600 DWARF_PATTERN. */
1601static void
f2206911 1602frv_frame_insn (rtx pattern, rtx dwarf_pattern)
36a05131
BS
1603{
1604 rtx insn = emit_insn (pattern);
1605 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
1606 REG_NOTES (insn) = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
1607 dwarf_pattern,
1608 REG_NOTES (insn));
1609}
1610
1611/* Emit instructions that transfer REG to or from the memory location (sp +
1612 STACK_OFFSET). The register is stored in memory if ACCESSOR->OP is
1613 FRV_STORE and loaded if it is FRV_LOAD. Only the prologue uses this
1614 function to store registers and only the epilogue uses it to load them.
1615
1616 The caller sets up ACCESSOR so that BASE is equal to (sp + BASE_OFFSET).
1617 The generated instruction will use BASE as its base register. BASE may
1618 simply be the stack pointer, but if several accesses are being made to a
1619 region far away from the stack pointer, it may be more efficient to set
1620 up a temporary instead.
b16c1435 1621
36a05131
BS
1622 Store instructions will be frame-related and will be annotated with the
1623 overall effect of the store. Load instructions will be followed by a
1624 (use) to prevent later optimizations from zapping them.
1625
1626 The function takes care of the moves to and from SPRs, using TEMP_REGNO
1627 as a temporary in such cases. */
1628static void
f2206911 1629frv_frame_access (frv_frame_accessor_t *accessor, rtx reg, int stack_offset)
36a05131
BS
1630{
1631 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reg);
1632 rtx mem = frv_frame_mem (mode,
1633 accessor->base,
1634 stack_offset - accessor->base_offset);
1635
1636 if (accessor->op == FRV_LOAD)
1637 {
1638 if (SPR_P (REGNO (reg)))
1639 {
1640 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (mode, TEMP_REGNO);
1641 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, mem));
1642 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, temp));
1643 }
1644 else
8d8256c1
NC
1645 {
1646 /* We cannot use reg+reg addressing for DImode access. */
1647 if (mode == DImode
1648 && GET_CODE (XEXP (mem, 0)) == PLUS
1649 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0)) == REG
1650 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)) == REG)
1651 {
1652 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, TEMP_REGNO);
5c5e8419
JR
1653
1654 emit_move_insn (temp,
1655 gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0),
1656 XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)));
8d8256c1
NC
1657 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, temp);
1658 }
1659 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, mem));
1660 }
c41c1387 1661 emit_use (reg);
36a05131
BS
1662 }
1663 else
1664 {
1665 if (SPR_P (REGNO (reg)))
1666 {
1667 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (mode, TEMP_REGNO);
1668 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, reg));
1669 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, temp),
1670 frv_dwarf_store (reg, stack_offset));
1671 }
8d8256c1 1672 else if (mode == DImode)
36a05131
BS
1673 {
1674 /* For DImode saves, the dwarf2 version needs to be a SEQUENCE
1675 with a separate save for each register. */
1676 rtx reg1 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (reg));
1677 rtx reg2 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (reg) + 1);
1678 rtx set1 = frv_dwarf_store (reg1, stack_offset);
1679 rtx set2 = frv_dwarf_store (reg2, stack_offset + 4);
8d8256c1
NC
1680
1681 /* Also we cannot use reg+reg addressing. */
1682 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (mem, 0)) == PLUS
1683 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0)) == REG
1684 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)) == REG)
1685 {
1686 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, TEMP_REGNO);
5c5e8419
JR
1687 emit_move_insn (temp,
1688 gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0),
1689 XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)));
8d8256c1
NC
1690 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, temp);
1691 }
1692
36a05131
BS
1693 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, reg),
1694 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
1695 gen_rtvec (2, set1, set2)));
1696 }
1697 else
1698 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, reg),
1699 frv_dwarf_store (reg, stack_offset));
1700 }
1701}
1702
1703/* A function that uses frv_frame_access to transfer a group of registers to
1704 or from the stack. ACCESSOR is passed directly to frv_frame_access, INFO
1705 is the stack information generated by frv_stack_info, and REG_SET is the
1706 number of the register set to transfer. */
1707static void
f2206911
KC
1708frv_frame_access_multi (frv_frame_accessor_t *accessor,
1709 frv_stack_t *info,
1710 int reg_set)
36a05131
BS
1711{
1712 frv_stack_regs_t *regs_info;
1713 int regno;
1714
1715 regs_info = &info->regs[reg_set];
1716 for (regno = regs_info->first; regno <= regs_info->last; regno++)
1717 if (info->save_p[regno])
1718 frv_frame_access (accessor,
1719 info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS
1720 ? gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno)
1721 : gen_rtx_REG (SImode, regno),
1722 info->reg_offset[regno]);
1723}
1724
1725/* Save or restore callee-saved registers that are kept outside the frame
1726 header. The function saves the registers if OP is FRV_STORE and restores
1727 them if OP is FRV_LOAD. INFO is the stack information generated by
1728 frv_stack_info. */
1729static void
f2206911 1730frv_frame_access_standard_regs (enum frv_stack_op op, frv_stack_t *info)
36a05131
BS
1731{
1732 frv_frame_accessor_t accessor;
1733
1734 accessor.op = op;
1735 accessor.base = stack_pointer_rtx;
1736 accessor.base_offset = 0;
1737 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_GPR);
1738 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_FPR);
1739 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_LCR);
b16c1435 1740}
36a05131
BS
1741
1742
1743/* Called after register allocation to add any instructions needed for the
1744 prologue. Using a prologue insn is favored compared to putting all of the
b88cf82e
KH
1745 instructions in the TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE target hook, since
1746 it allows the scheduler to intermix instructions with the saves of
1747 the caller saved registers. In some cases, it might be necessary
1748 to emit a barrier instruction as the last insn to prevent such
1749 scheduling.
36a05131
BS
1750
1751 Also any insns generated here should have RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P(insn) = 1
1752 so that the debug info generation code can handle them properly. */
1753void
f2206911 1754frv_expand_prologue (void)
36a05131
BS
1755{
1756 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
1757 rtx sp = stack_pointer_rtx;
1758 rtx fp = frame_pointer_rtx;
1759 frv_frame_accessor_t accessor;
1760
1761 if (TARGET_DEBUG_STACK)
1762 frv_debug_stack (info);
1763
1764 if (info->total_size == 0)
1765 return;
1766
1767 /* We're interested in three areas of the frame here:
1768
1769 A: the register save area
1770 B: the old FP
1771 C: the header after B
1772
1773 If the frame pointer isn't used, we'll have to set up A, B and C
1774 using the stack pointer. If the frame pointer is used, we'll access
1775 them as follows:
1776
1777 A: set up using sp
1778 B: set up using sp or a temporary (see below)
1779 C: set up using fp
1780
1781 We set up B using the stack pointer if the frame is small enough.
1782 Otherwise, it's more efficient to copy the old stack pointer into a
1783 temporary and use that.
1784
1785 Note that it's important to make sure the prologue and epilogue use the
1786 same registers to access A and C, since doing otherwise will confuse
1787 the aliasing code. */
1788
1789 /* Set up ACCESSOR for accessing region B above. If the frame pointer
1790 isn't used, the same method will serve for C. */
1791 accessor.op = FRV_STORE;
1792 if (frame_pointer_needed && info->total_size > 2048)
1793 {
36a05131
BS
1794 accessor.base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, OLD_SP_REGNO);
1795 accessor.base_offset = info->total_size;
5c5e8419 1796 emit_insn (gen_movsi (accessor.base, sp));
36a05131
BS
1797 }
1798 else
1799 {
1800 accessor.base = stack_pointer_rtx;
1801 accessor.base_offset = 0;
1802 }
1803
1804 /* Allocate the stack space. */
1805 {
1806 rtx asm_offset = frv_frame_offset_rtx (-info->total_size);
1807 rtx dwarf_offset = GEN_INT (-info->total_size);
1808
1809 frv_frame_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, asm_offset),
1810 gen_rtx_SET (Pmode,
1811 sp,
1812 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, sp, dwarf_offset)));
1813 }
1814
1815 /* If the frame pointer is needed, store the old one at (sp + FP_OFFSET)
1816 and point the new one to that location. */
1817 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1818 {
1819 int fp_offset = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
1820
1821 /* ASM_SRC and DWARF_SRC both point to the frame header. ASM_SRC is
1822 based on ACCESSOR.BASE but DWARF_SRC is always based on the stack
1823 pointer. */
1824 rtx asm_src = plus_constant (accessor.base,
1825 fp_offset - accessor.base_offset);
1826 rtx dwarf_src = plus_constant (sp, fp_offset);
1827
1828 /* Store the old frame pointer at (sp + FP_OFFSET). */
1829 frv_frame_access (&accessor, fp, fp_offset);
1830
1831 /* Set up the new frame pointer. */
1832 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, asm_src),
1833 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, dwarf_src));
1834
1835 /* Access region C from the frame pointer. */
1836 accessor.base = fp;
1837 accessor.base_offset = fp_offset;
1838 }
1839
1840 /* Set up region C. */
1841 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_STRUCT);
1842 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_LR);
1843 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_STDARG);
1844
1845 /* Set up region A. */
1846 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (FRV_STORE, info);
1847
1848 /* If this is a varargs/stdarg function, issue a blockage to prevent the
1849 scheduler from moving loads before the stores saving the registers. */
1850 if (info->stdarg_size > 0)
1851 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
1852
87b483a1 1853 /* Set up pic register/small data register for this function. */
ad516a74 1854 if (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table)
36a05131
BS
1855 emit_insn (gen_pic_prologue (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PIC_REGNO),
1856 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO),
1857 gen_rtx_REG (SImode, OFFSET_REGNO)));
1858}
1859
1860\f
1861/* Under frv, all of the work is done via frv_expand_epilogue, but
839a4992 1862 this function provides a convenient place to do cleanup. */
36a05131
BS
1863
1864static void
f2206911
KC
1865frv_function_epilogue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1866 HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131
BS
1867{
1868 frv_stack_cache = (frv_stack_t *)0;
1869
87b483a1 1870 /* Zap last used registers for conditional execution. */
fad205ff 1871 memset (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, 0, sizeof (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg));
36a05131 1872
87b483a1 1873 /* Release the bitmap of created insns. */
7b210806 1874 BITMAP_FREE (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap);
36a05131
BS
1875}
1876
1877\f
1878/* Called after register allocation to add any instructions needed for the
43aa4e05 1879 epilogue. Using an epilogue insn is favored compared to putting all of the
b88cf82e
KH
1880 instructions in the TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE target hook, since
1881 it allows the scheduler to intermix instructions with the saves of
1882 the caller saved registers. In some cases, it might be necessary
1883 to emit a barrier instruction as the last insn to prevent such
c557edf4 1884 scheduling. */
36a05131
BS
1885
1886void
764678d1 1887frv_expand_epilogue (bool emit_return)
36a05131
BS
1888{
1889 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
1890 rtx fp = frame_pointer_rtx;
1891 rtx sp = stack_pointer_rtx;
1892 rtx return_addr;
1893 int fp_offset;
1894
1895 fp_offset = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
1896
1897 /* Restore the stack pointer to its original value if alloca or the like
1898 is used. */
1899 if (! current_function_sp_is_unchanging)
1900 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (sp, fp, frv_frame_offset_rtx (-fp_offset)));
1901
1902 /* Restore the callee-saved registers that were used in this function. */
1903 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (FRV_LOAD, info);
1904
1905 /* Set RETURN_ADDR to the address we should return to. Set it to NULL if
1906 no return instruction should be emitted. */
764678d1 1907 if (info->save_p[LR_REGNO])
36a05131
BS
1908 {
1909 int lr_offset;
1910 rtx mem;
1911
1912 /* Use the same method to access the link register's slot as we did in
1913 the prologue. In other words, use the frame pointer if available,
1914 otherwise use the stack pointer.
1915
1916 LR_OFFSET is the offset of the link register's slot from the start
1917 of the frame and MEM is a memory rtx for it. */
1918 lr_offset = info->reg_offset[LR_REGNO];
1919 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1920 mem = frv_frame_mem (Pmode, fp, lr_offset - fp_offset);
1921 else
1922 mem = frv_frame_mem (Pmode, sp, lr_offset);
1923
1924 /* Load the old link register into a GPR. */
1925 return_addr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, TEMP_REGNO);
1926 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, return_addr, mem));
1927 }
1928 else
1929 return_addr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
1930
1931 /* Restore the old frame pointer. Emit a USE afterwards to make sure
1932 the load is preserved. */
1933 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1934 {
1935 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, fp)));
c41c1387 1936 emit_use (fp);
36a05131
BS
1937 }
1938
1939 /* Deallocate the stack frame. */
1940 if (info->total_size != 0)
1941 {
1942 rtx offset = frv_frame_offset_rtx (info->total_size);
1943 emit_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, offset));
1944 }
1945
1946 /* If this function uses eh_return, add the final stack adjustment now. */
e3b5732b 1947 if (crtl->calls_eh_return)
36a05131
BS
1948 emit_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX));
1949
764678d1 1950 if (emit_return)
36a05131 1951 emit_jump_insn (gen_epilogue_return (return_addr));
764678d1
AO
1952 else
1953 {
1954 rtx lr = return_addr;
1955
1956 if (REGNO (return_addr) != LR_REGNO)
1957 {
1958 lr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
1959 emit_move_insn (lr, return_addr);
1960 }
1961
c41c1387 1962 emit_use (lr);
764678d1 1963 }
36a05131
BS
1964}
1965
1966\f
b88cf82e 1967/* Worker function for TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK. */
36a05131 1968
c590b625 1969static void
f2206911
KC
1970frv_asm_output_mi_thunk (FILE *file,
1971 tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1972 HOST_WIDE_INT delta,
1973 HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1974 tree function)
36a05131
BS
1975{
1976 const char *name_func = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0), 0);
1977 const char *name_arg0 = reg_names[FIRST_ARG_REGNUM];
1978 const char *name_jmp = reg_names[JUMP_REGNO];
c557edf4 1979 const char *parallel = (frv_issue_rate () > 1 ? ".p" : "");
36a05131 1980
87b483a1 1981 /* Do the add using an addi if possible. */
2f5b1308 1982 if (IN_RANGE (delta, -2048, 2047))
eb0424da 1983 fprintf (file, "\taddi %s,#%d,%s\n", name_arg0, (int) delta, name_arg0);
36a05131
BS
1984 else
1985 {
4a0a75dd
KG
1986 const char *const name_add = reg_names[TEMP_REGNO];
1987 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #hi(" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "),%s\n",
1988 parallel, delta, name_add);
1989 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #lo(" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "),%s\n",
1990 delta, name_add);
36a05131
BS
1991 fprintf (file, "\tadd %s,%s,%s\n", name_add, name_arg0, name_arg0);
1992 }
1993
34208acf
AO
1994 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
1995 {
1996 const char *name_pic = reg_names[FDPIC_REGNO];
1997 name_jmp = reg_names[FDPIC_FPTR_REGNO];
1998
1999 if (flag_pic != 1)
2000 {
2001 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gotofffuncdeschi(", parallel);
2002 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2003 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2004
2005 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gotofffuncdesclo(");
2006 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2007 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2008
2009 fprintf (file, "\tldd @(%s,%s), %s\n", name_jmp, name_pic, name_jmp);
2010 }
2011 else
2012 {
2013 fprintf (file, "\tlddo @(%s,#gotofffuncdesc12(", name_pic);
2014 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2015 fprintf (file, "\t)), %s\n", name_jmp);
2016 }
2017 }
2018 else if (!flag_pic)
36a05131
BS
2019 {
2020 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #hi(", parallel);
2021 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2022 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2023
2024 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #lo(");
2025 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2026 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2027 }
2028 else
2029 {
2030 /* Use JUMP_REGNO as a temporary PIC register. */
2031 const char *name_lr = reg_names[LR_REGNO];
2032 const char *name_gppic = name_jmp;
2033 const char *name_tmp = reg_names[TEMP_REGNO];
2034
2035 fprintf (file, "\tmovsg %s,%s\n", name_lr, name_tmp);
2036 fprintf (file, "\tcall 1f\n");
2037 fprintf (file, "1:\tmovsg %s,%s\n", name_lr, name_gppic);
2038 fprintf (file, "\tmovgs %s,%s\n", name_tmp, name_lr);
2039 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gprelhi(1b),%s\n", parallel, name_tmp);
2040 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gprello(1b),%s\n", name_tmp);
2041 fprintf (file, "\tsub %s,%s,%s\n", name_gppic, name_tmp, name_gppic);
2042
2043 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gprelhi(", parallel);
2044 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2045 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_tmp);
2046
2047 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gprello(");
2048 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2049 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_tmp);
2050
2051 fprintf (file, "\tadd %s,%s,%s\n", name_gppic, name_tmp, name_jmp);
2052 }
2053
87b483a1 2054 /* Jump to the function address. */
36a05131
BS
2055 fprintf (file, "\tjmpl @(%s,%s)\n", name_jmp, reg_names[GPR_FIRST+0]);
2056}
2057
2058\f
36a05131 2059
87b483a1 2060/* On frv, create a frame whenever we need to create stack. */
36a05131 2061
b52b1749 2062static bool
f2206911 2063frv_frame_pointer_required (void)
36a05131 2064{
34208acf
AO
2065 /* If we forgoing the usual linkage requirements, we only need
2066 a frame pointer if the stack pointer might change. */
2067 if (!TARGET_LINKED_FP)
2068 return !current_function_sp_is_unchanging;
2069
36a05131 2070 if (! current_function_is_leaf)
b52b1749 2071 return true;
36a05131
BS
2072
2073 if (get_frame_size () != 0)
b52b1749 2074 return true;
36a05131
BS
2075
2076 if (cfun->stdarg)
b52b1749 2077 return true;
36a05131
BS
2078
2079 if (!current_function_sp_is_unchanging)
b52b1749 2080 return true;
36a05131 2081
ad516a74 2082 if (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table)
b52b1749 2083 return true;
36a05131
BS
2084
2085 if (profile_flag)
b52b1749 2086 return true;
36a05131
BS
2087
2088 if (cfun->machine->frame_needed)
b52b1749 2089 return true;
36a05131 2090
b52b1749 2091 return false;
36a05131
BS
2092}
2093
2094\f
7b5cbb57
AS
2095/* Worker function for TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE. */
2096
2097bool
2098frv_can_eliminate (const int from, const int to)
2099{
2100 return (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2101 ? ! frame_pointer_needed
2102 : true);
2103}
2104
36a05131
BS
2105/* This macro is similar to `INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET'. It specifies the
2106 initial difference between the specified pair of registers. This macro must
2107 be defined if `ELIMINABLE_REGS' is defined. */
2108
2109/* See frv_stack_info for more details on the frv stack frame. */
2110
2111int
f2206911 2112frv_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to)
36a05131
BS
2113{
2114 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
2115 int ret = 0;
2116
2117 if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
2118 ret = info->total_size - info->pretend_size;
2119
2120 else if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
88d6a75f 2121 ret = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
36a05131
BS
2122
2123 else if (to == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
2124 ret = (info->total_size
2125 - info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM]
2126 - info->pretend_size);
2127
2128 else
44e91694 2129 gcc_unreachable ();
36a05131
BS
2130
2131 if (TARGET_DEBUG_STACK)
2132 fprintf (stderr, "Eliminate %s to %s by adding %d\n",
2133 reg_names [from], reg_names[to], ret);
2134
2135 return ret;
2136}
2137
2138\f
d8c2bed3 2139/* Worker function for TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS. */
36a05131 2140
d8c2bed3 2141static void
d5cc9181 2142frv_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t cum_v,
f2206911
KC
2143 enum machine_mode mode,
2144 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2145 int *pretend_size,
2146 int second_time)
36a05131 2147{
d5cc9181
JR
2148 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
2149
36a05131
BS
2150 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2151 fprintf (stderr,
2152 "setup_vararg: words = %2d, mode = %4s, pretend_size = %d, second_time = %d\n",
2153 *cum, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), *pretend_size, second_time);
2154}
2155
2156\f
b88cf82e 2157/* Worker function for TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS. */
36a05131 2158
8ac411c7 2159static rtx
f2206911 2160frv_expand_builtin_saveregs (void)
36a05131
BS
2161{
2162 int offset = UNITS_PER_WORD * FRV_NUM_ARG_REGS;
2163
2164 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2165 fprintf (stderr, "expand_builtin_saveregs: offset from ap = %d\n",
2166 offset);
2167
f1c25d3b 2168 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_incoming_args_rtx, GEN_INT (- offset));
36a05131
BS
2169}
2170
2171\f
2172/* Expand __builtin_va_start to do the va_start macro. */
2173
d7bd8aeb 2174static void
f2206911 2175frv_expand_builtin_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg)
36a05131
BS
2176{
2177 tree t;
7dd68986 2178 int num = crtl->args.info - FIRST_ARG_REGNUM - FRV_NUM_ARG_REGS;
36a05131
BS
2179
2180 nextarg = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
2181 GEN_INT (UNITS_PER_WORD * num));
2182
2183 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2184 {
2185 fprintf (stderr, "va_start: args_info = %d, num = %d\n",
7dd68986 2186 crtl->args.info, num);
36a05131
BS
2187
2188 debug_rtx (nextarg);
2189 }
2190
726a989a 2191 t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist,
5be014d5
AP
2192 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (valist),
2193 make_tree (sizetype, nextarg)));
36a05131
BS
2194 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
2195
2196 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
2197}
2198
36a05131
BS
2199\f
2200/* Expand a block move operation, and return 1 if successful. Return 0
2201 if we should let the compiler generate normal code.
2202
2203 operands[0] is the destination
2204 operands[1] is the source
2205 operands[2] is the length
2206 operands[3] is the alignment */
2207
2208/* Maximum number of loads to do before doing the stores */
2209#ifndef MAX_MOVE_REG
2210#define MAX_MOVE_REG 4
2211#endif
2212
2213/* Maximum number of total loads to do. */
2214#ifndef TOTAL_MOVE_REG
2215#define TOTAL_MOVE_REG 8
2216#endif
2217
2218int
f2206911 2219frv_expand_block_move (rtx operands[])
36a05131
BS
2220{
2221 rtx orig_dest = operands[0];
2222 rtx orig_src = operands[1];
2223 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[2];
2224 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
2225 int constp = (GET_CODE (bytes_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2226 int align;
2227 int bytes;
2228 int offset;
2229 int num_reg;
2230 int i;
2231 rtx src_reg;
2232 rtx dest_reg;
2233 rtx src_addr;
2234 rtx dest_addr;
2235 rtx src_mem;
2236 rtx dest_mem;
2237 rtx tmp_reg;
2238 rtx stores[MAX_MOVE_REG];
2239 int move_bytes;
2240 enum machine_mode mode;
2241
87b483a1 2242 /* If this is not a fixed size move, just call memcpy. */
36a05131
BS
2243 if (! constp)
2244 return FALSE;
2245
44e91694
NS
2246 /* This should be a fixed size alignment. */
2247 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (align_rtx) == CONST_INT);
36a05131
BS
2248
2249 align = INTVAL (align_rtx);
2250
2251 /* Anything to move? */
2252 bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
2253 if (bytes <= 0)
2254 return TRUE;
2255
2256 /* Don't support real large moves. */
2257 if (bytes > TOTAL_MOVE_REG*align)
2258 return FALSE;
2259
2260 /* Move the address into scratch registers. */
2261 dest_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dest, 0));
2262 src_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_src, 0));
2263
2264 num_reg = offset = 0;
2265 for ( ; bytes > 0; (bytes -= move_bytes), (offset += move_bytes))
2266 {
87b483a1 2267 /* Calculate the correct offset for src/dest. */
36a05131
BS
2268 if (offset == 0)
2269 {
2270 src_addr = src_reg;
2271 dest_addr = dest_reg;
2272 }
2273 else
2274 {
2275 src_addr = plus_constant (src_reg, offset);
2276 dest_addr = plus_constant (dest_reg, offset);
2277 }
2278
2279 /* Generate the appropriate load and store, saving the stores
2280 for later. */
2281 if (bytes >= 4 && align >= 4)
2282 mode = SImode;
2283 else if (bytes >= 2 && align >= 2)
2284 mode = HImode;
2285 else
2286 mode = QImode;
2287
2288 move_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2289 tmp_reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2290 src_mem = change_address (orig_src, mode, src_addr);
2291 dest_mem = change_address (orig_dest, mode, dest_addr);
2292 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmp_reg, src_mem));
2293 stores[num_reg++] = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_mem, tmp_reg);
2294
2295 if (num_reg >= MAX_MOVE_REG)
2296 {
2297 for (i = 0; i < num_reg; i++)
2298 emit_insn (stores[i]);
2299 num_reg = 0;
2300 }
2301 }
2302
2303 for (i = 0; i < num_reg; i++)
2304 emit_insn (stores[i]);
2305
2306 return TRUE;
2307}
2308
2309\f
2310/* Expand a block clear operation, and return 1 if successful. Return 0
2311 if we should let the compiler generate normal code.
2312
2313 operands[0] is the destination
2314 operands[1] is the length
57e84f18 2315 operands[3] is the alignment */
36a05131
BS
2316
2317int
f2206911 2318frv_expand_block_clear (rtx operands[])
36a05131
BS
2319{
2320 rtx orig_dest = operands[0];
2321 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[1];
57e84f18 2322 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
36a05131
BS
2323 int constp = (GET_CODE (bytes_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2324 int align;
2325 int bytes;
2326 int offset;
36a05131
BS
2327 rtx dest_reg;
2328 rtx dest_addr;
2329 rtx dest_mem;
2330 int clear_bytes;
2331 enum machine_mode mode;
2332
87b483a1 2333 /* If this is not a fixed size move, just call memcpy. */
36a05131
BS
2334 if (! constp)
2335 return FALSE;
2336
44e91694
NS
2337 /* This should be a fixed size alignment. */
2338 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (align_rtx) == CONST_INT);
36a05131
BS
2339
2340 align = INTVAL (align_rtx);
2341
2342 /* Anything to move? */
2343 bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
2344 if (bytes <= 0)
2345 return TRUE;
2346
2347 /* Don't support real large clears. */
2348 if (bytes > TOTAL_MOVE_REG*align)
2349 return FALSE;
2350
2351 /* Move the address into a scratch register. */
2352 dest_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dest, 0));
2353
5c5e8419 2354 offset = 0;
36a05131
BS
2355 for ( ; bytes > 0; (bytes -= clear_bytes), (offset += clear_bytes))
2356 {
87b483a1 2357 /* Calculate the correct offset for src/dest. */
36a05131
BS
2358 dest_addr = ((offset == 0)
2359 ? dest_reg
2360 : plus_constant (dest_reg, offset));
2361
87b483a1 2362 /* Generate the appropriate store of gr0. */
36a05131
BS
2363 if (bytes >= 4 && align >= 4)
2364 mode = SImode;
2365 else if (bytes >= 2 && align >= 2)
2366 mode = HImode;
2367 else
2368 mode = QImode;
2369
2370 clear_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2371 dest_mem = change_address (orig_dest, mode, dest_addr);
2372 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_mem, const0_rtx));
2373 }
2374
2375 return TRUE;
2376}
2377
2378\f
2379/* The following variable is used to output modifiers of assembler
87b483a1 2380 code of the current output insn. */
36a05131
BS
2381
2382static rtx *frv_insn_operands;
2383
2384/* The following function is used to add assembler insn code suffix .p
87b483a1 2385 if it is necessary. */
36a05131
BS
2386
2387const char *
f2206911 2388frv_asm_output_opcode (FILE *f, const char *ptr)
36a05131
BS
2389{
2390 int c;
2391
c557edf4 2392 if (frv_insn_packing_flag <= 0)
36a05131
BS
2393 return ptr;
2394
2395 for (; *ptr && *ptr != ' ' && *ptr != '\t';)
2396 {
2397 c = *ptr++;
2398 if (c == '%' && ((*ptr >= 'a' && *ptr <= 'z')
2399 || (*ptr >= 'A' && *ptr <= 'Z')))
2400 {
2401 int letter = *ptr++;
2402
2403 c = atoi (ptr);
2404 frv_print_operand (f, frv_insn_operands [c], letter);
2405 while ((c = *ptr) >= '0' && c <= '9')
2406 ptr++;
2407 }
2408 else
2409 fputc (c, f);
2410 }
2411
c557edf4 2412 fprintf (f, ".p");
36a05131
BS
2413
2414 return ptr;
2415}
2416
c557edf4
RS
2417/* Set up the packing bit for the current output insn. Note that this
2418 function is not called for asm insns. */
36a05131
BS
2419
2420void
c557edf4
RS
2421frv_final_prescan_insn (rtx insn, rtx *opvec,
2422 int noperands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131 2423{
c557edf4 2424 if (INSN_P (insn))
36a05131 2425 {
c557edf4
RS
2426 if (frv_insn_packing_flag >= 0)
2427 {
2428 frv_insn_operands = opvec;
2429 frv_insn_packing_flag = PACKING_FLAG_P (insn);
2430 }
2431 else if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0
2432 && get_attr_acc_group (insn) == ACC_GROUP_ODD)
2433 /* Packing optimizations have been disabled, but INSN can only
2434 be issued in M1. Insert an mnop in M0. */
2435 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmnop.p\n");
36a05131 2436 }
36a05131
BS
2437}
2438
2439
2440\f
2441/* A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack frame
2442 where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that FRAMEADDR is
2443 an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame itself.
2444
2445 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value of
2446 FRAMEADDR--that is, the stack frame address is also the address of the stack
2447 word that points to the previous frame. */
2448
2449/* The default is correct, but we need to make sure the frame gets created. */
2450rtx
f2206911 2451frv_dynamic_chain_address (rtx frame)
36a05131
BS
2452{
2453 cfun->machine->frame_needed = 1;
2454 return frame;
2455}
2456
2457
2458/* A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2459 address for the frame COUNT steps up from the current frame, after the
2460 prologue. FRAMEADDR is the frame pointer of the COUNT frame, or the frame
2461 pointer of the COUNT - 1 frame if `RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME' is
2462 defined.
2463
2464 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when COUNT is
2465 zero, but may be `NULL_RTX' if there is not way to determine the return
2466 address of other frames. */
2467
2468rtx
34208acf 2469frv_return_addr_rtx (int count, rtx frame)
36a05131 2470{
34208acf
AO
2471 if (count != 0)
2472 return const0_rtx;
36a05131
BS
2473 cfun->machine->frame_needed = 1;
2474 return gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, plus_constant (frame, 8));
2475}
2476
2477/* Given a memory reference MEMREF, interpret the referenced memory as
2478 an array of MODE values, and return a reference to the element
2479 specified by INDEX. Assume that any pre-modification implicit in
2480 MEMREF has already happened.
2481
2482 MEMREF must be a legitimate operand for modes larger than SImode.
c6c3dba9 2483 frv_legitimate_address_p forbids register+register addresses, which
36a05131
BS
2484 this function cannot handle. */
2485rtx
f2206911 2486frv_index_memory (rtx memref, enum machine_mode mode, int index)
36a05131
BS
2487{
2488 rtx base = XEXP (memref, 0);
2489 if (GET_CODE (base) == PRE_MODIFY)
2490 base = XEXP (base, 0);
2491 return change_address (memref, mode,
2492 plus_constant (base, index * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)));
2493}
2494
2495\f
2496/* Print a memory address as an operand to reference that memory location. */
0fb30cb7 2497static void
f2206911 2498frv_print_operand_address (FILE * stream, rtx x)
36a05131
BS
2499{
2500 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
2501 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2502
2503 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2504 {
2505 case REG:
2506 fputs (reg_names [ REGNO (x)], stream);
2507 return;
2508
2509 case CONST_INT:
2510 fprintf (stream, "%ld", (long) INTVAL (x));
2511 return;
2512
2513 case SYMBOL_REF:
2514 assemble_name (stream, XSTR (x, 0));
2515 return;
2516
2517 case LABEL_REF:
2518 case CONST:
2519 output_addr_const (stream, x);
2520 return;
2521
8d8256c1
NC
2522 case PLUS:
2523 /* Poorly constructed asm statements can trigger this alternative.
2524 See gcc/testsuite/gcc.dg/asm-4.c for an example. */
2525 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (stream, x, 0);
2526 return;
2527
36a05131
BS
2528 default:
2529 break;
2530 }
2531
ab532386 2532 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_address:", x);
36a05131
BS
2533}
2534
2535\f
2536static void
f2206911 2537frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (FILE * stream, rtx x)
36a05131
BS
2538{
2539 int regno = true_regnum (x);
2540 if (GPR_P (regno))
2541 fputs (reg_names[regno], stream);
2542 else
ab532386 2543 fatal_insn ("bad register to frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg:", x);
36a05131
BS
2544}
2545
2546/* Print a memory reference suitable for the ld/st instructions. */
2547
2548static void
f2206911 2549frv_print_operand_memory_reference (FILE * stream, rtx x, int addr_offset)
36a05131 2550{
34208acf 2551 struct frv_unspec unspec;
36a05131
BS
2552 rtx x0 = NULL_RTX;
2553 rtx x1 = NULL_RTX;
2554
2555 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2556 {
2557 case SUBREG:
2558 case REG:
2559 x0 = x;
2560 break;
2561
2562 case PRE_MODIFY: /* (pre_modify (reg) (plus (reg) (reg))) */
2563 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
2564 x1 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1);
2565 break;
2566
2567 case CONST_INT:
2568 x1 = x;
2569 break;
2570
2571 case PLUS:
2572 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
2573 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
2574 if (GET_CODE (x0) == CONST_INT)
2575 {
2576 x0 = XEXP (x, 1);
2577 x1 = XEXP (x, 0);
2578 }
2579 break;
2580
2581 default:
ab532386 2582 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
36a05131
BS
2583 break;
2584
2585 }
2586
2587 if (addr_offset)
2588 {
2589 if (!x1)
2590 x1 = const0_rtx;
2591 else if (GET_CODE (x1) != CONST_INT)
ab532386 2592 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
36a05131
BS
2593 }
2594
2595 fputs ("@(", stream);
2596 if (!x0)
2597 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], stream);
2598 else if (GET_CODE (x0) == REG || GET_CODE (x0) == SUBREG)
2599 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (stream, x0);
2600 else
ab532386 2601 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
36a05131
BS
2602
2603 fputs (",", stream);
2604 if (!x1)
2605 fputs (reg_names [GPR_R0], stream);
2606
2607 else
2608 {
2609 switch (GET_CODE (x1))
2610 {
2611 case SUBREG:
2612 case REG:
2613 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (stream, x1);
2614 break;
2615
2616 case CONST_INT:
2617 fprintf (stream, "%ld", (long) (INTVAL (x1) + addr_offset));
2618 break;
2619
36a05131 2620 case CONST:
34208acf 2621 if (!frv_const_unspec_p (x1, &unspec))
ab532386 2622 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x1);
34208acf 2623 frv_output_const_unspec (stream, &unspec);
36a05131
BS
2624 break;
2625
2626 default:
ab532386 2627 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
36a05131
BS
2628 }
2629 }
2630
2631 fputs (")", stream);
2632}
2633
2634\f
2635/* Return 2 for likely branches and 0 for non-likely branches */
2636
2637#define FRV_JUMP_LIKELY 2
2638#define FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY 0
2639
2640static int
f2206911 2641frv_print_operand_jump_hint (rtx insn)
36a05131
BS
2642{
2643 rtx note;
2644 rtx labelref;
2645 int ret;
2646 HOST_WIDE_INT prob = -1;
2647 enum { UNKNOWN, BACKWARD, FORWARD } jump_type = UNKNOWN;
2648
44e91694 2649 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN);
36a05131
BS
2650
2651 /* Assume any non-conditional jump is likely. */
2652 if (! any_condjump_p (insn))
2653 ret = FRV_JUMP_LIKELY;
2654
2655 else
2656 {
2657 labelref = condjump_label (insn);
2658 if (labelref)
2659 {
2660 rtx label = XEXP (labelref, 0);
2661 jump_type = (insn_current_address > INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (label))
2662 ? BACKWARD
2663 : FORWARD);
2664 }
2665
2666 note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_BR_PROB, 0);
2667 if (!note)
2668 ret = ((jump_type == BACKWARD) ? FRV_JUMP_LIKELY : FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY);
2669
2670 else
2671 {
2672 prob = INTVAL (XEXP (note, 0));
2673 ret = ((prob >= (REG_BR_PROB_BASE / 2))
2674 ? FRV_JUMP_LIKELY
2675 : FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY);
2676 }
2677 }
2678
2679#if 0
2680 if (TARGET_DEBUG)
2681 {
2682 char *direction;
2683
2684 switch (jump_type)
2685 {
2686 default:
2687 case UNKNOWN: direction = "unknown jump direction"; break;
2688 case BACKWARD: direction = "jump backward"; break;
2689 case FORWARD: direction = "jump forward"; break;
2690 }
2691
2692 fprintf (stderr,
2693 "%s: uid %ld, %s, probability = %ld, max prob. = %ld, hint = %d\n",
2694 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (current_function_decl)),
2695 (long)INSN_UID (insn), direction, (long)prob,
2696 (long)REG_BR_PROB_BASE, ret);
2697 }
2698#endif
2699
2700 return ret;
2701}
2702
2703\f
036ff63f
RS
2704/* Return the comparison operator to use for CODE given that the ICC
2705 register is OP0. */
2706
2707static const char *
2708comparison_string (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0)
2709{
2710 bool is_nz_p = GET_MODE (op0) == CC_NZmode;
2711 switch (code)
2712 {
2713 default: output_operand_lossage ("bad condition code");
2714 case EQ: return "eq";
2715 case NE: return "ne";
2716 case LT: return is_nz_p ? "n" : "lt";
2717 case LE: return "le";
2718 case GT: return "gt";
2719 case GE: return is_nz_p ? "p" : "ge";
2720 case LTU: return is_nz_p ? "no" : "c";
2721 case LEU: return is_nz_p ? "eq" : "ls";
2722 case GTU: return is_nz_p ? "ne" : "hi";
2723 case GEU: return is_nz_p ? "ra" : "nc";
2724 }
2725}
2726
43aa4e05 2727/* Print an operand to an assembler instruction.
36a05131
BS
2728
2729 `%' followed by a letter and a digit says to output an operand in an
0fb30cb7
NF
2730 alternate fashion. Four letters have standard, built-in meanings
2731 described below. The hook `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND' can define
2732 additional letters with nonstandard meanings.
36a05131
BS
2733
2734 `%cDIGIT' can be used to substitute an operand that is a constant value
2735 without the syntax that normally indicates an immediate operand.
2736
2737 `%nDIGIT' is like `%cDIGIT' except that the value of the constant is negated
2738 before printing.
2739
2740 `%aDIGIT' can be used to substitute an operand as if it were a memory
2741 reference, with the actual operand treated as the address. This may be
2742 useful when outputting a "load address" instruction, because often the
2743 assembler syntax for such an instruction requires you to write the operand
2744 as if it were a memory reference.
2745
2746 `%lDIGIT' is used to substitute a `label_ref' into a jump instruction.
2747
2748 `%=' outputs a number which is unique to each instruction in the entire
2749 compilation. This is useful for making local labels to be referred to more
2750 than once in a single template that generates multiple assembler
2751 instructions.
2752
0fb30cb7
NF
2753 `%' followed by a punctuation character specifies a substitution that
2754 does not use an operand. Only one case is standard: `%%' outputs a
2755 `%' into the assembler code. Other nonstandard cases can be defined
2756 in the `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND' hook. You must also define which
2757 punctuation characters are valid with the
2758 `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P' hook. */
36a05131 2759
0fb30cb7 2760static void
f2206911 2761frv_print_operand (FILE * file, rtx x, int code)
36a05131 2762{
34208acf 2763 struct frv_unspec unspec;
36a05131
BS
2764 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
2765 int offset;
2766
0a2aaacc 2767 if (code != 0 && !ISALPHA (code))
36a05131
BS
2768 value = 0;
2769
2770 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
2771 value = INTVAL (x);
2772
2773 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2774 {
2775 if (GET_MODE (x) == SFmode)
2776 {
2777 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
2778 long l;
2779
2780 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, x);
2781 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, l);
2782 value = l;
2783 }
2784
2785 else if (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
2786 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x);
2787
2788 else
ab532386 2789 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, bad const_double", x);
36a05131
BS
2790 }
2791
2792 else
2793 value = 0;
2794
2795 switch (code)
2796 {
2797
2798 case '.':
87b483a1 2799 /* Output r0. */
36a05131
BS
2800 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], file);
2801 break;
2802
2803 case '#':
2804 fprintf (file, "%d", frv_print_operand_jump_hint (current_output_insn));
2805 break;
2806
0f6e5d45 2807 case '@':
87b483a1 2808 /* Output small data area base register (gr16). */
36a05131
BS
2809 fputs (reg_names[SDA_BASE_REG], file);
2810 break;
2811
2812 case '~':
87b483a1 2813 /* Output pic register (gr17). */
36a05131
BS
2814 fputs (reg_names[PIC_REGNO], file);
2815 break;
2816
2817 case '*':
87b483a1 2818 /* Output the temporary integer CCR register. */
36a05131
BS
2819 fputs (reg_names[ICR_TEMP], file);
2820 break;
2821
2822 case '&':
87b483a1 2823 /* Output the temporary integer CC register. */
36a05131
BS
2824 fputs (reg_names[ICC_TEMP], file);
2825 break;
2826
87b483a1 2827 /* case 'a': print an address. */
36a05131
BS
2828
2829 case 'C':
87b483a1 2830 /* Print appropriate test for integer branch false operation. */
036ff63f
RS
2831 fputs (comparison_string (reverse_condition (GET_CODE (x)),
2832 XEXP (x, 0)), file);
36a05131
BS
2833 break;
2834
36a05131 2835 case 'c':
87b483a1 2836 /* Print appropriate test for integer branch true operation. */
036ff63f 2837 fputs (comparison_string (GET_CODE (x), XEXP (x, 0)), file);
36a05131
BS
2838 break;
2839
2840 case 'e':
2841 /* Print 1 for a NE and 0 for an EQ to give the final argument
2842 for a conditional instruction. */
2843 if (GET_CODE (x) == NE)
2844 fputs ("1", file);
2845
2846 else if (GET_CODE (x) == EQ)
2847 fputs ("0", file);
2848
2849 else
ab532386 2850 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'e' modifier:", x);
36a05131
BS
2851 break;
2852
2853 case 'F':
87b483a1 2854 /* Print appropriate test for floating point branch false operation. */
36a05131
BS
2855 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2856 {
2857 default:
ab532386 2858 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'F' modifier:", x);
36a05131
BS
2859
2860 case EQ: fputs ("ne", file); break;
2861 case NE: fputs ("eq", file); break;
2862 case LT: fputs ("uge", file); break;
2863 case LE: fputs ("ug", file); break;
2864 case GT: fputs ("ule", file); break;
2865 case GE: fputs ("ul", file); break;
2866 }
2867 break;
2868
2869 case 'f':
87b483a1 2870 /* Print appropriate test for floating point branch true operation. */
36a05131
BS
2871 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2872 {
2873 default:
ab532386 2874 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'f' modifier:", x);
36a05131
BS
2875
2876 case EQ: fputs ("eq", file); break;
2877 case NE: fputs ("ne", file); break;
2878 case LT: fputs ("lt", file); break;
2879 case LE: fputs ("le", file); break;
2880 case GT: fputs ("gt", file); break;
2881 case GE: fputs ("ge", file); break;
2882 }
2883 break;
2884
34208acf
AO
2885 case 'g':
2886 /* Print appropriate GOT function. */
2887 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
ab532386 2888 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'g' modifier:", x);
34208acf
AO
2889 fputs (unspec_got_name (INTVAL (x)), file);
2890 break;
2891
36a05131
BS
2892 case 'I':
2893 /* Print 'i' if the operand is a constant, or is a memory reference that
87b483a1 2894 adds a constant. */
36a05131
BS
2895 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
2896 x = ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
2897 ? XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)
2898 : XEXP (x, 0));
34208acf
AO
2899 else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
2900 x = XEXP (x, 1);
36a05131
BS
2901
2902 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2903 {
2904 default:
2905 break;
2906
2907 case CONST_INT:
2908 case SYMBOL_REF:
2909 case CONST:
2910 fputs ("i", file);
2911 break;
2912 }
2913 break;
2914
2915 case 'i':
2916 /* For jump instructions, print 'i' if the operand is a constant or
87b483a1 2917 is an expression that adds a constant. */
36a05131
BS
2918 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
2919 fputs ("i", file);
2920
2921 else
2922 {
2923 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
2924 || (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
2925 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2926 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT)))
2927 fputs ("i", file);
2928 }
2929 break;
2930
2931 case 'L':
2932 /* Print the lower register of a double word register pair */
2933 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
2934 fputs (reg_names[ REGNO (x)+1 ], file);
2935 else
ab532386 2936 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'L' modifier:", x);
36a05131
BS
2937 break;
2938
87b483a1 2939 /* case 'l': print a LABEL_REF. */
36a05131
BS
2940
2941 case 'M':
2942 case 'N':
2943 /* Print a memory reference for ld/st/jmp, %N prints a memory reference
2944 for the second word of double memory operations. */
2945 offset = (code == 'M') ? 0 : UNITS_PER_WORD;
2946 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2947 {
2948 default:
ab532386 2949 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'M/N' modifier:", x);
36a05131
BS
2950
2951 case MEM:
2952 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (file, XEXP (x, 0), offset);
2953 break;
2954
2955 case REG:
2956 case SUBREG:
2957 case CONST_INT:
2958 case PLUS:
2959 case SYMBOL_REF:
2960 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (file, x, offset);
2961 break;
2962 }
2963 break;
2964
2965 case 'O':
2966 /* Print the opcode of a command. */
2967 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2968 {
2969 default:
ab532386 2970 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'O' modifier:", x);
36a05131
BS
2971
2972 case PLUS: fputs ("add", file); break;
2973 case MINUS: fputs ("sub", file); break;
2974 case AND: fputs ("and", file); break;
2975 case IOR: fputs ("or", file); break;
2976 case XOR: fputs ("xor", file); break;
2977 case ASHIFT: fputs ("sll", file); break;
2978 case ASHIFTRT: fputs ("sra", file); break;
2979 case LSHIFTRT: fputs ("srl", file); break;
2980 }
2981 break;
2982
87b483a1 2983 /* case 'n': negate and print a constant int. */
36a05131
BS
2984
2985 case 'P':
2986 /* Print PIC label using operand as the number. */
2987 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
ab532386 2988 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, P modifier:", x);
36a05131
BS
2989
2990 fprintf (file, ".LCF%ld", (long)INTVAL (x));
2991 break;
2992
2993 case 'U':
87b483a1 2994 /* Print 'u' if the operand is a update load/store. */
36a05131
BS
2995 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PRE_MODIFY)
2996 fputs ("u", file);
2997 break;
2998
2999 case 'z':
87b483a1 3000 /* If value is 0, print gr0, otherwise it must be a register. */
36a05131
BS
3001 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (x) == 0)
3002 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], file);
3003
3004 else if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
3005 fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
3006
3007 else
ab532386 3008 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, z case", x);
36a05131
BS
3009 break;
3010
3011 case 'x':
87b483a1 3012 /* Print constant in hex. */
36a05131
BS
3013 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
3014 {
3015 fprintf (file, "%s0x%.4lx", IMMEDIATE_PREFIX, (long) value);
3016 break;
3017 }
3018
87b483a1 3019 /* Fall through. */
36a05131
BS
3020
3021 case '\0':
3022 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
3023 fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
3024
3025 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
3026 || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
3027 fprintf (file, "%s%ld", IMMEDIATE_PREFIX, (long) value);
3028
34208acf
AO
3029 else if (frv_const_unspec_p (x, &unspec))
3030 frv_output_const_unspec (file, &unspec);
3031
36a05131
BS
3032 else if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
3033 frv_print_operand_address (file, XEXP (x, 0));
3034
3035 else if (CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (x))
3036 frv_print_operand_address (file, x);
3037
3038 else
ab532386 3039 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, 0 case", x);
36a05131
BS
3040
3041 break;
3042
3043 default:
3044 fatal_insn ("frv_print_operand: unknown code", x);
3045 break;
3046 }
3047
3048 return;
3049}
3050
0fb30cb7
NF
3051static bool
3052frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code)
3053{
3054 return (code == '.' || code == '#' || code == '@' || code == '~'
3055 || code == '*' || code == '&');
3056}
3057
36a05131
BS
3058\f
3059/* A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable CUM for the
3060 state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable has type
3061 `CUMULATIVE_ARGS'. The value of FNTYPE is the tree node for the data type
3062 of the function which will receive the args, or 0 if the args are to a
3063 compiler support library function. The value of INDIRECT is nonzero when
3064 processing an indirect call, for example a call through a function pointer.
3065 The value of INDIRECT is zero for a call to an explicitly named function, a
3066 library function call, or when `INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS' is used to find
3067 arguments for the function being compiled.
3068
3069 When processing a call to a compiler support library function, LIBNAME
3070 identifies which one. It is a `symbol_ref' rtx which contains the name of
3071 the function, as a string. LIBNAME is 0 when an ordinary C function call is
3072 being processed. Thus, each time this macro is called, either LIBNAME or
3073 FNTYPE is nonzero, but never both of them at once. */
3074
3075void
f2206911
KC
3076frv_init_cumulative_args (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3077 tree fntype,
3078 rtx libname,
3079 tree fndecl,
3080 int incoming)
36a05131
BS
3081{
3082 *cum = FIRST_ARG_REGNUM;
3083
3084 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3085 {
3086 fprintf (stderr, "\ninit_cumulative_args:");
563a317a 3087 if (!fndecl && fntype)
36a05131
BS
3088 fputs (" indirect", stderr);
3089
3090 if (incoming)
3091 fputs (" incoming", stderr);
3092
3093 if (fntype)
3094 {
3095 tree ret_type = TREE_TYPE (fntype);
3096 fprintf (stderr, " return=%s,",
3097 tree_code_name[ (int)TREE_CODE (ret_type) ]);
3098 }
3099
3100 if (libname && GET_CODE (libname) == SYMBOL_REF)
3101 fprintf (stderr, " libname=%s", XSTR (libname, 0));
3102
3103 if (cfun->returns_struct)
3104 fprintf (stderr, " return-struct");
3105
3106 putc ('\n', stderr);
3107 }
3108}
3109
3110\f
fe984136
RH
3111/* Return true if we should pass an argument on the stack rather than
3112 in registers. */
3113
3114static bool
586de218 3115frv_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type)
fe984136
RH
3116{
3117 if (mode == BLKmode)
3118 return true;
3119 if (type == NULL)
3120 return false;
3121 return AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type);
3122}
3123
36a05131
BS
3124/* If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits, of an
3125 argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
3126 `PARM_BOUNDARY' is used for all arguments. */
3127
c2ed6cf8 3128static unsigned int
f2206911 3129frv_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
c2ed6cf8 3130 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131
BS
3131{
3132 return BITS_PER_WORD;
3133}
3134
88a1f47f 3135static rtx
d5cc9181 3136frv_function_arg_1 (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode,
88a1f47f
NF
3137 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool named,
3138 bool incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131 3139{
d5cc9181
JR
3140 const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
3141
36a05131
BS
3142 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3143 int arg_num = *cum;
3144 rtx ret;
3145 const char *debstr;
3146
3147 /* Return a marker for use in the call instruction. */
3148 if (xmode == VOIDmode)
3149 {
3150 ret = const0_rtx;
3151 debstr = "<0>";
3152 }
3153
3154 else if (arg_num <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM)
3155 {
f1c25d3b 3156 ret = gen_rtx_REG (xmode, arg_num);
36a05131
BS
3157 debstr = reg_names[arg_num];
3158 }
3159
3160 else
3161 {
3162 ret = NULL_RTX;
3163 debstr = "memory";
3164 }
3165
3166 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3167 fprintf (stderr,
3168 "function_arg: words = %2d, mode = %4s, named = %d, size = %3d, arg = %s\n",
3169 arg_num, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), named, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), debstr);
3170
3171 return ret;
3172}
3173
88a1f47f 3174static rtx
d5cc9181 3175frv_function_arg (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
88a1f47f
NF
3176 const_tree type, bool named)
3177{
3178 return frv_function_arg_1 (cum, mode, type, named, false);
3179}
3180
3181static rtx
d5cc9181 3182frv_function_incoming_arg (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
88a1f47f
NF
3183 const_tree type, bool named)
3184{
3185 return frv_function_arg_1 (cum, mode, type, named, true);
3186}
3187
36a05131
BS
3188\f
3189/* A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable CUM to
3190 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values MODE, TYPE and
3191 NAMED describe that argument. Once this is done, the variable CUM is
3192 suitable for analyzing the *following* argument with `FUNCTION_ARG', etc.
3193
3194 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed on
3195 the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space used
3196 for arguments without any special help. */
3197
88a1f47f 3198static void
d5cc9181 3199frv_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t cum_v,
f2206911 3200 enum machine_mode mode,
88a1f47f
NF
3201 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3202 bool named)
36a05131 3203{
d5cc9181
JR
3204 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
3205
36a05131
BS
3206 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3207 int bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (xmode);
3208 int words = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3209 int arg_num = *cum;
3210
3211 *cum = arg_num + words;
3212
3213 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3214 fprintf (stderr,
3215 "function_adv: words = %2d, mode = %4s, named = %d, size = %3d\n",
3216 arg_num, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), named, words * UNITS_PER_WORD);
3217}
3218
3219\f
3220/* A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an argument,
3221 must be put in registers. The value must be zero for arguments that are
3222 passed entirely in registers or that are entirely pushed on the stack.
3223
3224 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in registers
3225 and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the first N words of
3226 arguments are passed in registers, and the rest on the stack. If a
3227 multi-word argument (a `double' or a structure) crosses that boundary, its
3228 first few words must be passed in registers and the rest must be pushed.
3229 This macro tells the compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words
3230 should go in registers.
3231
3232 `FUNCTION_ARG' for these arguments should return the first register to be
3233 used by the caller for this argument; likewise `FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG', for
3234 the called function. */
3235
78a52f11 3236static int
d5cc9181 3237frv_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
78a52f11 3238 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131 3239{
d5cc9181 3240
36a05131
BS
3241 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3242 int bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (xmode);
3243 int words = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
d5cc9181 3244 int arg_num = *get_cumulative_args (cum);
36a05131
BS
3245 int ret;
3246
3247 ret = ((arg_num <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM && arg_num + words > LAST_ARG_REGNUM+1)
3248 ? LAST_ARG_REGNUM - arg_num + 1
3249 : 0);
78a52f11 3250 ret *= UNITS_PER_WORD;
36a05131
BS
3251
3252 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG && ret)
78a52f11 3253 fprintf (stderr, "frv_arg_partial_bytes: %d\n", ret);
36a05131
BS
3254
3255 return ret;
36a05131
BS
3256}
3257
219d92a4
AS
3258\f
3259/* Implements TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE. */
3260
3261static rtx
3262frv_function_value (const_tree valtype,
3263 const_tree fn_decl_or_type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3264 bool outgoing ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3265{
3266 return gen_rtx_REG (TYPE_MODE (valtype), RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3267}
3268
3269\f
3270/* Implements TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE. */
3271
3272static rtx
3273frv_libcall_value (enum machine_mode mode,
3274 const_rtx fun ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3275{
3276 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3277}
3278
3279\f
3280/* Implements FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P. */
3281
3282bool
3283frv_function_value_regno_p (const unsigned int regno)
3284{
3285 return (regno == RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3286}
36a05131
BS
3287\f
3288/* Return true if a register is ok to use as a base or index register. */
3289
3290static FRV_INLINE int
f2206911 3291frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (int regno, int strict_p)
36a05131
BS
3292{
3293 if (GPR_P (regno))
3294 return TRUE;
3295
3296 if (strict_p)
3297 return (reg_renumber[regno] >= 0 && GPR_P (reg_renumber[regno]));
3298
3299 if (regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
3300 return TRUE;
3301
3302 return (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
3303}
3304
3305\f
3306/* A C compound statement with a conditional `goto LABEL;' executed if X (an
3307 RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the target machine for a memory
3308 operand of mode MODE.
3309
3310 It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as subroutines for
3311 this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to understand.
3312
3313 This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a non-strict
3314 one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
3315 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
3316 considered a memory reference. In contexts where some kind of register is
3317 required, a pseudo-register with no hard register must be rejected.
3318
3319 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
3320 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of register is
3321 required.
3322
3323 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this macro
3324 define the macro `REG_OK_STRICT'. You should use an `#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT'
3325 conditional to define the strict variant in that case and the non-strict
3326 variant otherwise.
3327
36a05131
BS
3328 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a `symbol_ref' and an
3329 integer are stored inside a `const' RTX to mark them as constant.
3330 Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums specifically as
3331 legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply recognize any `const' as
3332 legitimate.
3333
0fb30cb7
NF
3334 Usually `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS' is not prepared to handle
3335 constant sums that are not marked with `const'. It assumes that a
3336 naked `plus' indicates indexing. If so, then you *must* reject such
3337 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them
3338 will be given to `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS'. */
36a05131
BS
3339
3340int
c6c3dba9
PB
3341frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (enum machine_mode mode,
3342 rtx x,
3343 int strict_p,
3344 int condexec_p,
3345 int allow_double_reg_p)
36a05131
BS
3346{
3347 rtx x0, x1;
3348 int ret = 0;
3349 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
3350 unsigned regno0;
3351
bef8809e
AH
3352 if (FRV_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (x))
3353 return 0;
3354
36a05131
BS
3355 switch (GET_CODE (x))
3356 {
3357 default:
3358 break;
3359
3360 case SUBREG:
3361 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
3362 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
3363 break;
3364
87b483a1 3365 /* Fall through. */
36a05131
BS
3366
3367 case REG:
3368 ret = frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x), strict_p);
3369 break;
3370
3371 case PRE_MODIFY:
3372 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3373 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3374 if (GET_CODE (x0) != REG
3375 || ! frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x0), strict_p)
3376 || GET_CODE (x1) != PLUS
3377 || ! rtx_equal_p (x0, XEXP (x1, 0))
3378 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x1, 1)) != REG
3379 || ! frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (XEXP (x1, 1)), strict_p))
3380 break;
3381
3382 ret = 1;
3383 break;
3384
3385 case CONST_INT:
2300b9dd 3386 /* 12-bit immediate */
36a05131
BS
3387 if (condexec_p)
3388 ret = FALSE;
3389 else
3390 {
2f5b1308 3391 ret = IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x), -2048, 2047);
36a05131
BS
3392
3393 /* If we can't use load/store double operations, make sure we can
3394 address the second word. */
3395 if (ret && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
2f5b1308
JR
3396 ret = IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x) + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1,
3397 -2048, 2047);
36a05131
BS
3398 }
3399 break;
3400
3401 case PLUS:
3402 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3403 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3404
3405 if (GET_CODE (x0) == SUBREG)
3406 x0 = SUBREG_REG (x0);
3407
3408 if (GET_CODE (x0) != REG)
3409 break;
3410
3411 regno0 = REGNO (x0);
3412 if (!frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (regno0, strict_p))
3413 break;
3414
3415 switch (GET_CODE (x1))
3416 {
3417 default:
3418 break;
3419
3420 case SUBREG:
3421 x1 = SUBREG_REG (x1);
3422 if (GET_CODE (x1) != REG)
3423 break;
3424
87b483a1 3425 /* Fall through. */
36a05131
BS
3426
3427 case REG:
87b483a1
KH
3428 /* Do not allow reg+reg addressing for modes > 1 word if we
3429 can't depend on having move double instructions. */
34208acf 3430 if (!allow_double_reg_p && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
36a05131
BS
3431 ret = FALSE;
3432 else
3433 ret = frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x1), strict_p);
3434 break;
3435
3436 case CONST_INT:
2300b9dd 3437 /* 12-bit immediate */
36a05131
BS
3438 if (condexec_p)
3439 ret = FALSE;
3440 else
3441 {
3442 value = INTVAL (x1);
2f5b1308 3443 ret = IN_RANGE (value, -2048, 2047);
36a05131
BS
3444
3445 /* If we can't use load/store double operations, make sure we can
3446 address the second word. */
3447 if (ret && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
2f5b1308 3448 ret = IN_RANGE (value + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1, -2048, 2047);
36a05131
BS
3449 }
3450 break;
3451
36a05131 3452 case CONST:
34208acf 3453 if (!condexec_p && got12_operand (x1, VOIDmode))
36a05131
BS
3454 ret = TRUE;
3455 break;
3456
3457 }
3458 break;
3459 }
3460
3461 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ADDR)
3462 {
331d9186 3463 fprintf (stderr, "\n========== legitimate_address_p, mode = %s, result = %d, addresses are %sstrict%s\n",
36a05131
BS
3464 GET_MODE_NAME (mode), ret, (strict_p) ? "" : "not ",
3465 (condexec_p) ? ", inside conditional code" : "");
3466 debug_rtx (x);
3467 }
3468
3469 return ret;
3470}
3471
c6c3dba9
PB
3472bool
3473frv_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, bool strict_p)
3474{
3475 return frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, x, strict_p, FALSE, FALSE);
3476}
3477
bef8809e
AH
3478/* Given an ADDR, generate code to inline the PLT. */
3479static rtx
3480gen_inlined_tls_plt (rtx addr)
3481{
fdbe66f2 3482 rtx retval, dest;
bef8809e
AH
3483 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, FDPIC_REG);
3484
3485
3486 dest = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3487
3488 if (flag_pic == 1)
3489 {
3490 /*
3491 -fpic version:
3492
3493 lddi.p @(gr15, #gottlsdesc12(ADDR)), gr8
3494 calll #gettlsoff(ADDR)@(gr8, gr0)
3495 */
3496 emit_insn (gen_tls_lddi (dest, addr, picreg));
3497 }
3498 else
3499 {
3500 /*
3501 -fPIC version:
3502
3503 sethi.p #gottlsdeschi(ADDR), gr8
3504 setlo #gottlsdesclo(ADDR), gr8
3505 ldd #tlsdesc(ADDR)@(gr15, gr8), gr8
3506 calll #gettlsoff(ADDR)@(gr8, gr0)
3507 */
3508 rtx reguse = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3509 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (reguse, addr, GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCHI)));
3510 emit_insn (gen_tls_tlsdesc_ldd (dest, picreg, reguse, addr));
3511 }
3512
3513 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
a701780f 3514 emit_insn (gen_tls_indirect_call (retval, addr, dest, picreg));
bef8809e
AH
3515 return retval;
3516}
3517
3518/* Emit a TLSMOFF or TLSMOFF12 offset, depending on -mTLS. Returns
3519 the destination address. */
3520static rtx
3521gen_tlsmoff (rtx addr, rtx reg)
3522{
3523 rtx dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3524
3525 if (TARGET_BIG_TLS)
3526 {
3527 /* sethi.p #tlsmoffhi(x), grA
3528 setlo #tlsmofflo(x), grA
3529 */
3530 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3531 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (dest, addr,
3532 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI)));
3533 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, reg);
3534 }
3535 else
3536 {
3537 /* addi grB, #tlsmoff12(x), grC
3538 -or-
3539 ld/st @(grB, #tlsmoff12(x)), grC
3540 */
3541 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3542 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg_i (dest, addr, reg,
3543 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFF12)));
3544 }
3545 return dest;
3546}
3547
3548/* Generate code for a TLS address. */
3549static rtx
3550frv_legitimize_tls_address (rtx addr, enum tls_model model)
3551{
3552 rtx dest, tp = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 29);
3553 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, 15);
3554
3555 switch (model)
3556 {
3557 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
3558 if (flag_pic == 1)
3559 {
3560 /* -fpic version.
3561 ldi @(gr15, #gottlsoff12(x)), gr5
3562 */
3563 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3564 emit_insn (gen_tls_load_gottlsoff12 (dest, addr, picreg));
3565 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, dest);
3566 }
3567 else
3568 {
3569 /* -fPIC or anything else.
3570
3571 sethi.p #gottlsoffhi(x), gr14
3572 setlo #gottlsofflo(x), gr14
3573 ld #tlsoff(x)@(gr15, gr14), gr9
3574 */
3575 rtx tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3576 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3577 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (tmp, addr,
3578 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_HI)));
3579
3580 emit_insn (gen_tls_tlsoff_ld (dest, picreg, tmp, addr));
3581 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, dest);
3582 }
3583 break;
3584 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
3585 {
3586 rtx reg, retval;
3587
3588 if (TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3589 retval = gen_inlined_tls_plt (GEN_INT (0));
3590 else
3591 {
3592 /* call #gettlsoff(0) */
3593 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3594 emit_insn (gen_call_gettlsoff (retval, GEN_INT (0), picreg));
3595 }
3596
3597 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3598 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg,
3599 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3600 retval, tp)));
3601
3602 dest = gen_tlsmoff (addr, reg);
3603
3604 /*
3605 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3606 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (dest, addr,
3607 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI)));
3608 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, reg);
3609 */
3610 break;
3611 }
3612 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
3613 dest = gen_tlsmoff (addr, gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 29));
3614 break;
3615 case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC:
3616 {
3617 rtx retval;
3618
3619 if (TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3620 retval = gen_inlined_tls_plt (addr);
3621 else
3622 {
3623 /* call #gettlsoff(x) */
3624 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3625 emit_insn (gen_call_gettlsoff (retval, addr, picreg));
3626 }
3627 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, retval, tp);
3628 break;
3629 }
3630 default:
44e91694 3631 gcc_unreachable ();
bef8809e
AH
3632 }
3633
3634 return dest;
3635}
3636
2a2e3f05 3637rtx
bef8809e 3638frv_legitimize_address (rtx x,
2a2e3f05
AH
3639 rtx oldx ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3640 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3641{
bef8809e
AH
3642 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
3643 {
3644 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x);
3645 if (model != 0)
3646 return frv_legitimize_tls_address (x, model);
3647 }
3648
506d7b68 3649 return x;
2a2e3f05 3650}
36a05131 3651\f
34208acf
AO
3652/* Test whether a local function descriptor is canonical, i.e.,
3653 whether we can use FUNCDESC_GOTOFF to compute the address of the
3654 function. */
3655
3656static bool
3657frv_local_funcdesc_p (rtx fnx)
3658{
3659 tree fn;
3660 enum symbol_visibility vis;
3661 bool ret;
36a05131 3662
34208acf
AO
3663 if (! SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (fnx))
3664 return FALSE;
3665
3666 fn = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (fnx);
3667
3668 if (! fn)
3669 return FALSE;
36a05131 3670
34208acf 3671 vis = DECL_VISIBILITY (fn);
36a05131 3672
34208acf
AO
3673 if (vis == VISIBILITY_PROTECTED)
3674 /* Private function descriptors for protected functions are not
3675 canonical. Temporarily change the visibility to global. */
3676 vis = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
3677 else if (flag_shlib)
3678 /* If we're already compiling for a shared library (that, unlike
3679 executables, can't assume that the existence of a definition
3680 implies local binding), we can skip the re-testing. */
3681 return TRUE;
36a05131 3682
34208acf 3683 ret = default_binds_local_p_1 (fn, flag_pic);
36a05131 3684
34208acf
AO
3685 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = vis;
3686
3687 return ret;
3688}
3689
3690/* Load the _gp symbol into DEST. SRC is supposed to be the FDPIC
3691 register. */
36a05131
BS
3692
3693rtx
34208acf
AO
3694frv_gen_GPsym2reg (rtx dest, rtx src)
3695{
3696 tree gp = get_identifier ("_gp");
3697 rtx gp_sym = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (gp));
36a05131 3698
34208acf
AO
3699 return gen_symGOT2reg (dest, gp_sym, src, GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOT12));
3700}
3701
3702static const char *
3703unspec_got_name (int i)
3704{
3705 switch (i)
36a05131 3706 {
34208acf
AO
3707 case R_FRV_GOT12: return "got12";
3708 case R_FRV_GOTHI: return "gothi";
3709 case R_FRV_GOTLO: return "gotlo";
3710 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC: return "funcdesc";
3711 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOT12: return "gotfuncdesc12";
3712 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTHI: return "gotfuncdeschi";
3713 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTLO: return "gotfuncdesclo";
3714 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_VALUE: return "funcdescvalue";
3715 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12: return "gotofffuncdesc12";
3716 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFFHI: return "gotofffuncdeschi";
3717 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFFLO: return "gotofffuncdesclo";
3718 case R_FRV_GOTOFF12: return "gotoff12";
3719 case R_FRV_GOTOFFHI: return "gotoffhi";
3720 case R_FRV_GOTOFFLO: return "gotofflo";
3721 case R_FRV_GPREL12: return "gprel12";
3722 case R_FRV_GPRELHI: return "gprelhi";
3723 case R_FRV_GPRELLO: return "gprello";
bef8809e
AH
3724 case R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_HI: return "gottlsoffhi";
3725 case R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_LO: return "gottlsofflo";
3726 case R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI: return "tlsmoffhi";
3727 case R_FRV_TLSMOFFLO: return "tlsmofflo";
3728 case R_FRV_TLSMOFF12: return "tlsmoff12";
3729 case R_FRV_TLSDESCHI: return "tlsdeschi";
3730 case R_FRV_TLSDESCLO: return "tlsdesclo";
3731 case R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCHI: return "gottlsdeschi";
3732 case R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCLO: return "gottlsdesclo";
44e91694 3733 default: gcc_unreachable ();
36a05131 3734 }
34208acf 3735}
36a05131 3736
34208acf
AO
3737/* Write the assembler syntax for UNSPEC to STREAM. Note that any offset
3738 is added inside the relocation operator. */
3739
3740static void
3741frv_output_const_unspec (FILE *stream, const struct frv_unspec *unspec)
3742{
3743 fprintf (stream, "#%s(", unspec_got_name (unspec->reloc));
3744 output_addr_const (stream, plus_constant (unspec->symbol, unspec->offset));
3745 fputs (")", stream);
3746}
3747
3748/* Implement FIND_BASE_TERM. See whether ORIG_X represents #gprel12(foo)
3749 or #gotoff12(foo) for some small data symbol foo. If so, return foo,
3750 otherwise return ORIG_X. */
3751
3752rtx
3753frv_find_base_term (rtx x)
3754{
3755 struct frv_unspec unspec;
3756
3757 if (frv_const_unspec_p (x, &unspec)
3758 && frv_small_data_reloc_p (unspec.symbol, unspec.reloc))
3759 return plus_constant (unspec.symbol, unspec.offset);
3760
3761 return x;
36a05131
BS
3762}
3763
3764/* Return 1 if operand is a valid FRV address. CONDEXEC_P is true if
3765 the operand is used by a predicated instruction. */
3766
6d26dc3b 3767int
f2206911 3768frv_legitimate_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode, int condexec_p)
36a05131
BS
3769{
3770 return ((GET_MODE (op) == mode || mode == VOIDmode)
3771 && GET_CODE (op) == MEM
c6c3dba9
PB
3772 && frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, XEXP (op, 0),
3773 reload_completed, condexec_p, FALSE));
34208acf
AO
3774}
3775
3776void
764678d1 3777frv_expand_fdpic_call (rtx *operands, bool ret_value, bool sibcall)
34208acf
AO
3778{
3779 rtx lr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
3780 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (SImode, FDPIC_REG);
3781 rtx c, rvrtx=0;
3782 rtx addr;
3783
3784 if (ret_value)
3785 {
3786 rvrtx = operands[0];
3787 operands ++;
3788 }
3789
3790 addr = XEXP (operands[0], 0);
3791
3792 /* Inline PLTs if we're optimizing for speed. We'd like to inline
3793 any calls that would involve a PLT, but can't tell, since we
3794 don't know whether an extern function is going to be provided by
3795 a separate translation unit or imported from a separate module.
3796 When compiling for shared libraries, if the function has default
3797 visibility, we assume it's overridable, so we inline the PLT, but
3798 for executables, we don't really have a way to make a good
3799 decision: a function is as likely to be imported from a shared
3800 library as it is to be defined in the executable itself. We
3801 assume executables will get global functions defined locally,
3802 whereas shared libraries will have them potentially overridden,
3803 so we only inline PLTs when compiling for shared libraries.
3804
3805 In order to mark a function as local to a shared library, any
3806 non-default visibility attribute suffices. Unfortunately,
3807 there's no simple way to tag a function declaration as ``in a
3808 different module'', which we could then use to trigger PLT
3809 inlining on executables. There's -minline-plt, but it affects
3810 all external functions, so one would have to also mark function
3811 declarations available in the same module with non-default
3812 visibility, which is advantageous in itself. */
764678d1
AO
3813 if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF
3814 && ((!SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (addr) && TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3815 || sibcall))
34208acf
AO
3816 {
3817 rtx x, dest;
3818 dest = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
3819 if (flag_pic != 1)
3820 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, addr, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
3821 GEN_INT (R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12));
3822 else
3823 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, addr, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
3824 GEN_INT (R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12));
3825 emit_insn (x);
ad516a74 3826 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
34208acf 3827 addr = dest;
2396bce1 3828 }
34208acf
AO
3829 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
3830 {
3831 /* These are always either local, or handled through a local
3832 PLT. */
3833 if (ret_value)
3834 c = gen_call_value_fdpicsi (rvrtx, addr, operands[1],
3835 operands[2], picreg, lr);
3836 else
3837 c = gen_call_fdpicsi (addr, operands[1], operands[2], picreg, lr);
3838 emit_call_insn (c);
3839 return;
3840 }
3841 else if (! ldd_address_operand (addr, Pmode))
3842 addr = force_reg (Pmode, addr);
3843
3844 picreg = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3845 emit_insn (gen_movdi_ldd (picreg, addr));
3846
764678d1
AO
3847 if (sibcall && ret_value)
3848 c = gen_sibcall_value_fdpicdi (rvrtx, picreg, const0_rtx);
3849 else if (sibcall)
3850 c = gen_sibcall_fdpicdi (picreg, const0_rtx);
3851 else if (ret_value)
34208acf
AO
3852 c = gen_call_value_fdpicdi (rvrtx, picreg, const0_rtx, lr);
3853 else
3854 c = gen_call_fdpicdi (picreg, const0_rtx, lr);
3855 emit_call_insn (c);
36a05131 3856}
36a05131 3857\f
6d26dc3b
KH
3858/* Look for a SYMBOL_REF of a function in an rtx. We always want to
3859 process these separately from any offsets, such that we add any
3860 offsets to the function descriptor (the actual pointer), not to the
3861 function address. */
36a05131 3862
6d26dc3b
KH
3863static bool
3864frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (rtx x)
36a05131 3865{
6d26dc3b
KH
3866 const char *format;
3867 int length;
3868 int j;
36a05131 3869
6d26dc3b
KH
3870 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
3871 return SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (x);
34208acf 3872
6d26dc3b
KH
3873 length = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x));
3874 format = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
36a05131 3875
6d26dc3b 3876 for (j = 0; j < length; ++j)
36a05131 3877 {
6d26dc3b
KH
3878 switch (format[j])
3879 {
3880 case 'e':
3881 if (frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XEXP (x, j)))
3882 return TRUE;
3883 break;
36a05131 3884
6d26dc3b
KH
3885 case 'V':
3886 case 'E':
3887 if (XVEC (x, j) != 0)
3888 {
3889 int k;
3890 for (k = 0; k < XVECLEN (x, j); ++k)
3891 if (frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XVECEXP (x, j, k)))
3892 return TRUE;
3893 }
3894 break;
36a05131 3895
6d26dc3b
KH
3896 default:
3897 /* Nothing to do. */
3898 break;
3899 }
36a05131
BS
3900 }
3901
36a05131
BS
3902 return FALSE;
3903}
3904
6d26dc3b
KH
3905/* Return true if the memory operand is one that can be conditionally
3906 executed. */
36a05131 3907
f2206911 3908int
6d26dc3b 3909condexec_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
36a05131 3910{
6d26dc3b
KH
3911 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (op);
3912 rtx addr;
36a05131 3913
6d26dc3b 3914 if (mode != VOIDmode && op_mode != mode)
36a05131
BS
3915 return FALSE;
3916
6d26dc3b 3917 switch (op_mode)
36a05131
BS
3918 {
3919 default:
6d26dc3b 3920 return FALSE;
36a05131 3921
6d26dc3b
KH
3922 case QImode:
3923 case HImode:
3924 case SImode:
3925 case SFmode:
36a05131
BS
3926 break;
3927 }
3928
6d26dc3b 3929 if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM)
36a05131
BS
3930 return FALSE;
3931
6d26dc3b 3932 addr = XEXP (op, 0);
c6c3dba9 3933 return frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, addr, reload_completed, TRUE, FALSE);
36a05131 3934}
36a05131
BS
3935\f
3936/* Return true if the bare return instruction can be used outside of the
3937 epilog code. For frv, we only do it if there was no stack allocation. */
3938
3939int
f2206911 3940direct_return_p (void)
36a05131
BS
3941{
3942 frv_stack_t *info;
3943
3944 if (!reload_completed)
3945 return FALSE;
3946
3947 info = frv_stack_info ();
3948 return (info->total_size == 0);
3949}
3950
3951\f
2a2e3f05
AH
3952void
3953frv_emit_move (enum machine_mode mode, rtx dest, rtx src)
3954{
bef8809e
AH
3955 if (GET_CODE (src) == SYMBOL_REF)
3956 {
3957 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (src);
3958 if (model != 0)
3959 src = frv_legitimize_tls_address (src, model);
3960 }
3961
2a2e3f05
AH
3962 switch (mode)
3963 {
3964 case SImode:
3965 if (frv_emit_movsi (dest, src))
3966 return;
3967 break;
3968
3969 case QImode:
3970 case HImode:
3971 case DImode:
3972 case SFmode:
3973 case DFmode:
3974 if (!reload_in_progress
3975 && !reload_completed
3976 && !register_operand (dest, mode)
3977 && !reg_or_0_operand (src, mode))
3978 src = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, src);
3979 break;
3980
3981 default:
44e91694 3982 gcc_unreachable ();
2a2e3f05
AH
3983 }
3984
3985 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src));
3986}
3987
36a05131
BS
3988/* Emit code to handle a MOVSI, adding in the small data register or pic
3989 register if needed to load up addresses. Return TRUE if the appropriate
3990 instructions are emitted. */
3991
3992int
f2206911 3993frv_emit_movsi (rtx dest, rtx src)
36a05131
BS
3994{
3995 int base_regno = -1;
34208acf
AO
3996 int unspec = 0;
3997 rtx sym = src;
3998 struct frv_unspec old_unspec;
36a05131
BS
3999
4000 if (!reload_in_progress
4001 && !reload_completed
4002 && !register_operand (dest, SImode)
4003 && (!reg_or_0_operand (src, SImode)
4004 /* Virtual registers will almost always be replaced by an
4005 add instruction, so expose this to CSE by copying to
87b483a1 4006 an intermediate register. */
36a05131 4007 || (GET_CODE (src) == REG
2f5b1308
JR
4008 && IN_RANGE (REGNO (src),
4009 FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER,
4010 LAST_VIRTUAL_POINTER_REGISTER))))
36a05131
BS
4011 {
4012 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, src)));
4013 return TRUE;
4014 }
4015
4016 /* Explicitly add in the PIC or small data register if needed. */
4017 switch (GET_CODE (src))
4018 {
4019 default:
4020 break;
4021
4022 case LABEL_REF:
34208acf
AO
4023 handle_label:
4024 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
4025 {
4026 /* Using GPREL12, we use a single GOT entry for all symbols
4027 in read-only sections, but trade sequences such as:
4028
4029 sethi #gothi(label), gr#
4030 setlo #gotlo(label), gr#
4031 ld @(gr15,gr#), gr#
4032
4033 for
4034
4035 ld @(gr15,#got12(_gp)), gr#
4036 sethi #gprelhi(label), gr##
4037 setlo #gprello(label), gr##
4038 add gr#, gr##, gr##
4039
4040 We may often be able to share gr# for multiple
4041 computations of GPREL addresses, and we may often fold
4042 the final add into the pair of registers of a load or
4043 store instruction, so it's often profitable. Even when
4044 optimizing for size, we're trading a GOT entry for an
4045 additional instruction, which trades GOT space
4046 (read-write) for code size (read-only, shareable), as
4047 long as the symbol is not used in more than two different
4048 locations.
2396bce1 4049
34208acf
AO
4050 With -fpie/-fpic, we'd be trading a single load for a
4051 sequence of 4 instructions, because the offset of the
4ee31f1e 4052 label can't be assumed to be addressable with 12 bits, so
34208acf
AO
4053 we don't do this. */
4054 if (TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4055 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4056 else
4057 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4058 }
4059 else if (flag_pic)
36a05131
BS
4060 base_regno = PIC_REGNO;
4061
4062 break;
4063
4064 case CONST:
34208acf
AO
4065 if (frv_const_unspec_p (src, &old_unspec))
4066 break;
36a05131 4067
34208acf
AO
4068 if (TARGET_FDPIC && frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XEXP (src, 0)))
4069 {
4070 handle_whatever:
4071 src = force_reg (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)), XEXP (src, 0));
4072 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
4073 return TRUE;
4074 }
4075 else
4076 {
4077 sym = XEXP (sym, 0);
4078 if (GET_CODE (sym) == PLUS
4079 && GET_CODE (XEXP (sym, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
4080 && GET_CODE (XEXP (sym, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4081 sym = XEXP (sym, 0);
4082 if (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF)
4083 goto handle_sym;
4084 else if (GET_CODE (sym) == LABEL_REF)
4085 goto handle_label;
4086 else
4087 goto handle_whatever;
4088 }
36a05131
BS
4089 break;
4090
4091 case SYMBOL_REF:
34208acf
AO
4092 handle_sym:
4093 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
4094 {
bef8809e
AH
4095 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (sym);
4096
4097 if (model != 0)
4098 {
4099 src = frv_legitimize_tls_address (src, model);
4100 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
4101 return TRUE;
4102 }
4103
34208acf
AO
4104 if (SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (sym))
4105 {
4106 if (frv_local_funcdesc_p (sym))
4107 unspec = R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12;
4108 else
4109 unspec = R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOT12;
4110 }
4111 else
4112 {
4113 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (sym))
4114 switch (GET_CODE (get_pool_constant (sym)))
4115 {
4116 case CONST:
4117 case SYMBOL_REF:
4118 case LABEL_REF:
4119 if (flag_pic)
4120 {
4121 unspec = R_FRV_GOTOFF12;
4122 break;
4123 }
4124 /* Fall through. */
4125 default:
4126 if (TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4127 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4128 else
4129 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4130 break;
4131 }
4132 else if (SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (sym)
4133 && !SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (sym)
4134 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym)
4135 && (!DECL_P (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym))
4136 || !DECL_COMMON (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym))))
4137 {
4138 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym);
4139 tree init = TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
4140 ? DECL_INITIAL (decl)
4141 : TREE_CODE (decl) == CONSTRUCTOR
4142 ? decl : 0;
4143 int reloc = 0;
4144 bool named_section, readonly;
4145
4146 if (init && init != error_mark_node)
4147 reloc = compute_reloc_for_constant (init);
2396bce1 4148
34208acf
AO
4149 named_section = TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
4150 && lookup_attribute ("section", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl));
4151 readonly = decl_readonly_section (decl, reloc);
2396bce1 4152
34208acf
AO
4153 if (named_section)
4154 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4155 else if (!readonly)
4156 unspec = R_FRV_GOTOFF12;
4157 else if (readonly && TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4158 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4159 else
4160 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4161 }
4162 else
4163 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4164 }
4165 }
4166
4167 else if (SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (sym))
36a05131
BS
4168 base_regno = SDA_BASE_REG;
4169
4170 else if (flag_pic)
4171 base_regno = PIC_REGNO;
4172
4173 break;
4174 }
4175
4176 if (base_regno >= 0)
4177 {
34208acf
AO
4178 if (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (sym))
4179 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src,
4180 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base_regno),
4181 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GPREL12)));
4182 else
4183 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src,
4184 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base_regno),
4185 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GPREL12)));
36a05131 4186 if (base_regno == PIC_REGNO)
ad516a74 4187 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
34208acf
AO
4188 return TRUE;
4189 }
36a05131 4190
34208acf
AO
4191 if (unspec)
4192 {
4193 rtx x;
4194
4195 /* Since OUR_FDPIC_REG is a pseudo register, we can't safely introduce
4196 new uses of it once reload has begun. */
44e91694 4197 gcc_assert (!reload_in_progress && !reload_completed);
34208acf
AO
4198
4199 switch (unspec)
4200 {
4201 case R_FRV_GOTOFF12:
4202 if (!frv_small_data_reloc_p (sym, unspec))
4203 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4204 GEN_INT (unspec));
4205 else
4206 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4207 break;
4208 case R_FRV_GPREL12:
4209 if (!frv_small_data_reloc_p (sym, unspec))
4210 x = gen_symGPREL2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4211 GEN_INT (unspec));
4212 else
4213 x = gen_symGPREL2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4214 break;
4215 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12:
4216 if (flag_pic != 1)
4217 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4218 GEN_INT (unspec));
4219 else
4220 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4221 break;
4222 default:
4223 if (flag_pic != 1)
4224 x = gen_symGOT2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4225 GEN_INT (unspec));
4226 else
4227 x = gen_symGOT2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4228 break;
4229 }
4230 emit_insn (x);
ad516a74 4231 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
36a05131
BS
4232 return TRUE;
4233 }
4234
34208acf 4235
36a05131
BS
4236 return FALSE;
4237}
4238
4239\f
4240/* Return a string to output a single word move. */
4241
4242const char *
f2206911 4243output_move_single (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
36a05131
BS
4244{
4245 rtx dest = operands[0];
4246 rtx src = operands[1];
4247
4248 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4249 {
4250 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4251 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4252
4253 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4254 {
4255 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4256 {
4257 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4258 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4259
4260 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4261 return "mov %1, %0";
4262
4263 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4264 return "movfg %1, %0";
4265
4266 else if (SPR_P (src_regno))
4267 return "movsg %1, %0";
4268 }
4269
4270 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4271 {
4272 /* gpr <- memory */
4273 switch (mode)
4274 {
4275 default:
4276 break;
4277
4278 case QImode:
4279 return "ldsb%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4280
4281 case HImode:
4282 return "ldsh%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4283
4284 case SImode:
4285 case SFmode:
4286 return "ld%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4287 }
4288 }
4289
4290 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
4291 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST_DOUBLE)
4292 {
4293 /* gpr <- integer/floating constant */
4294 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
4295
4296 if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT)
4297 value = INTVAL (src);
4298
4299 else if (mode == SFmode)
4300 {
4301 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
4302 long l;
4303
4304 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, src);
4305 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, l);
4306 value = l;
4307 }
4308
4309 else
4310 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (src);
4311
2f5b1308 4312 if (IN_RANGE (value, -32768, 32767))
36a05131
BS
4313 return "setlos %1, %0";
4314
4315 return "#";
4316 }
4317
4318 else if (GET_CODE (src) == SYMBOL_REF
4319 || GET_CODE (src) == LABEL_REF
4320 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST)
4321 {
36a05131
BS
4322 return "#";
4323 }
4324 }
4325
4326 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4327 {
4328 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4329 {
4330 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4331 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4332
4333 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4334 return "movgf %1, %0";
4335
4336 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4337 {
4338 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4339 return "fmovs %1, %0";
4340 else
4341 return "mor %1, %1, %0";
4342 }
4343 }
4344
4345 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4346 {
4347 /* fpr <- memory */
4348 switch (mode)
4349 {
4350 default:
4351 break;
4352
4353 case QImode:
4354 return "ldbf%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4355
4356 case HImode:
4357 return "ldhf%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4358
4359 case SImode:
4360 case SFmode:
4361 return "ldf%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4362 }
4363 }
4364
4365 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4366 return "movgf %., %0";
4367 }
4368
4369 else if (SPR_P (dest_regno))
4370 {
4371 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4372 {
4373 /* spr <- some sort of register */
4374 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4375
4376 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4377 return "movgs %1, %0";
4378 }
c557edf4
RS
4379 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4380 return "movgs %., %0";
36a05131
BS
4381 }
4382 }
4383
4384 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4385 {
4386 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4387 {
4388 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4389 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4390
4391 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4392 {
4393 switch (mode)
4394 {
4395 default:
4396 break;
4397
4398 case QImode:
4399 return "stb%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4400
4401 case HImode:
4402 return "sth%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4403
4404 case SImode:
4405 case SFmode:
4406 return "st%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4407 }
4408 }
4409
4410 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4411 {
4412 switch (mode)
4413 {
4414 default:
4415 break;
4416
4417 case QImode:
4418 return "stbf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4419
4420 case HImode:
4421 return "sthf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4422
4423 case SImode:
4424 case SFmode:
4425 return "stf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4426 }
4427 }
4428 }
4429
4430 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4431 {
4432 switch (GET_MODE (dest))
4433 {
4434 default:
4435 break;
4436
4437 case QImode:
4438 return "stb%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4439
4440 case HImode:
4441 return "sth%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4442
4443 case SImode:
4444 case SFmode:
4445 return "st%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4446 }
4447 }
4448 }
4449
ab532386 4450 fatal_insn ("bad output_move_single operand", insn);
36a05131
BS
4451 return "";
4452}
4453
4454\f
4455/* Return a string to output a double word move. */
4456
4457const char *
f2206911 4458output_move_double (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
36a05131
BS
4459{
4460 rtx dest = operands[0];
4461 rtx src = operands[1];
4462 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4463
4464 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4465 {
4466 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4467
4468 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4469 {
4470 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4471 {
4472 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4473 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4474
4475 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4476 return "#";
4477
4478 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4479 {
4480 if (((dest_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4481 && ((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4482 return "movfgd %1, %0";
4483
4484 return "#";
4485 }
4486 }
4487
4488 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4489 {
4490 /* gpr <- memory */
4491 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (src, mode))
4492 return "ldd%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4493
4494 return "#";
4495 }
4496
4497 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
4498 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST_DOUBLE)
4499 return "#";
4500 }
4501
4502 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4503 {
4504 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4505 {
4506 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4507 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4508
4509 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4510 {
4511 if (((dest_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4512 && ((src_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4513 return "movgfd %1, %0";
4514
4515 return "#";
4516 }
4517
4518 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4519 {
4520 if (TARGET_DOUBLE
4521 && ((dest_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4522 && ((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4523 return "fmovd %1, %0";
4524
4525 return "#";
4526 }
4527 }
4528
4529 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4530 {
4531 /* fpr <- memory */
4532 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (src, mode))
4533 return "lddf%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4534
4535 return "#";
4536 }
4537
4538 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4539 return "#";
4540 }
4541 }
4542
4543 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4544 {
4545 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4546 {
4547 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4548
4549 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4550 {
4551 if (((src_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4552 && dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4553 return "std%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4554
4555 return "#";
4556 }
4557
4558 if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4559 {
4560 if (((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4561 && dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4562 return "stdf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4563
4564 return "#";
4565 }
4566 }
4567
4568 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4569 {
4570 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4571 return "std%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4572
4573 return "#";
4574 }
4575 }
4576
ab532386 4577 fatal_insn ("bad output_move_double operand", insn);
36a05131
BS
4578 return "";
4579}
4580
4581\f
4582/* Return a string to output a single word conditional move.
4583 Operand0 -- EQ/NE of ccr register and 0
4584 Operand1 -- CCR register
4585 Operand2 -- destination
4586 Operand3 -- source */
4587
4588const char *
f2206911 4589output_condmove_single (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
36a05131
BS
4590{
4591 rtx dest = operands[2];
4592 rtx src = operands[3];
4593
4594 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4595 {
4596 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4597 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4598
4599 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4600 {
4601 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4602 {
4603 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4604 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4605
4606 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4607 return "cmov %z3, %2, %1, %e0";
4608
4609 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4610 return "cmovfg %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4611 }
4612
4613 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4614 {
4615 /* gpr <- memory */
4616 switch (mode)
4617 {
4618 default:
4619 break;
4620
4621 case QImode:
4622 return "cldsb%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4623
4624 case HImode:
4625 return "cldsh%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4626
4627 case SImode:
4628 case SFmode:
4629 return "cld%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4630 }
4631 }
4632
4633 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4634 return "cmov %., %2, %1, %e0";
4635 }
4636
4637 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4638 {
4639 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4640 {
4641 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4642 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4643
4644 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4645 return "cmovgf %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4646
4647 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4648 {
4649 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4650 return "cfmovs %3,%2,%1,%e0";
4651 else
4652 return "cmor %3, %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4653 }
4654 }
4655
4656 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4657 {
4658 /* fpr <- memory */
4659 if (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode)
4660 return "cldf%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4661 }
4662
4663 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4664 return "cmovgf %., %2, %1, %e0";
4665 }
4666 }
4667
4668 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4669 {
4670 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4671 {
4672 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4673 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4674
4675 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4676 {
4677 switch (mode)
4678 {
4679 default:
4680 break;
4681
4682 case QImode:
4683 return "cstb%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4684
4685 case HImode:
4686 return "csth%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4687
4688 case SImode:
4689 case SFmode:
4690 return "cst%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4691 }
4692 }
4693
4694 else if (FPR_P (src_regno) && (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode))
4695 return "cstf%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4696 }
4697
4698 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4699 {
4700 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4701 switch (mode)
4702 {
4703 default:
4704 break;
4705
4706 case QImode:
4707 return "cstb%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4708
4709 case HImode:
4710 return "csth%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4711
4712 case SImode:
4713 case SFmode:
4714 return "cst%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4715 }
4716 }
4717 }
4718
ab532386 4719 fatal_insn ("bad output_condmove_single operand", insn);
36a05131
BS
4720 return "";
4721}
4722
4723\f
4724/* Emit the appropriate code to do a comparison, returning the register the
4725 comparison was done it. */
4726
4727static rtx
f2206911 4728frv_emit_comparison (enum rtx_code test, rtx op0, rtx op1)
36a05131
BS
4729{
4730 enum machine_mode cc_mode;
4731 rtx cc_reg;
4732
87b483a1 4733 /* Floating point doesn't have comparison against a constant. */
36a05131
BS
4734 if (GET_MODE (op0) == CC_FPmode && GET_CODE (op1) != REG)
4735 op1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op1);
4736
4737 /* Possibly disable using anything but a fixed register in order to work
4738 around cse moving comparisons past function calls. */
4739 cc_mode = SELECT_CC_MODE (test, op0, op1);
4740 cc_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4741 ? gen_reg_rtx (cc_mode)
4742 : gen_rtx_REG (cc_mode,
4743 (cc_mode == CC_FPmode) ? FCC_FIRST : ICC_FIRST));
4744
4745 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cc_reg,
4746 gen_rtx_COMPARE (cc_mode, op0, op1)));
4747
4748 return cc_reg;
4749}
4750
4751\f
f90b7a5a 4752/* Emit code for a conditional branch.
36a05131
BS
4753 XXX: I originally wanted to add a clobber of a CCR register to use in
4754 conditional execution, but that confuses the rest of the compiler. */
4755
4756int
f90b7a5a 4757frv_emit_cond_branch (rtx operands[])
36a05131
BS
4758{
4759 rtx test_rtx;
4760 rtx label_ref;
4761 rtx if_else;
f90b7a5a
PB
4762 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
4763 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, operands[1], operands[2]);
36a05131
BS
4764 enum machine_mode cc_mode = GET_MODE (cc_reg);
4765
4766 /* Branches generate:
4767 (set (pc)
4768 (if_then_else (<test>, <cc_reg>, (const_int 0))
4769 (label_ref <branch_label>)
4770 (pc))) */
f90b7a5a 4771 label_ref = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, operands[3]);
1c563bed 4772 test_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, cc_mode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
36a05131
BS
4773 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (cc_mode, test_rtx, label_ref, pc_rtx);
4774 emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx, if_else));
4775 return TRUE;
4776}
4777
4778\f
f90b7a5a 4779/* Emit code to set a gpr to 1/0 based on a comparison. */
36a05131
BS
4780
4781int
f90b7a5a 4782frv_emit_scc (rtx operands[])
36a05131
BS
4783{
4784 rtx set;
4785 rtx test_rtx;
4786 rtx clobber;
4787 rtx cr_reg;
f90b7a5a
PB
4788 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (operands[1]);
4789 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, operands[2], operands[3]);
36a05131
BS
4790
4791 /* SCC instructions generate:
4792 (parallel [(set <target> (<test>, <cc_reg>, (const_int 0))
4793 (clobber (<ccr_reg>))]) */
4794 test_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, SImode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
f90b7a5a 4795 set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operands[0], test_rtx);
36a05131
BS
4796
4797 cr_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4798 ? gen_reg_rtx (CC_CCRmode)
4799 : gen_rtx_REG (CC_CCRmode,
4800 ((GET_MODE (cc_reg) == CC_FPmode)
4801 ? FCR_FIRST
4802 : ICR_FIRST)));
4803
4804 clobber = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, cr_reg);
4805 emit_insn (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, set, clobber)));
4806 return TRUE;
4807}
4808
4809\f
4810/* Split a SCC instruction into component parts, returning a SEQUENCE to hold
839a4992 4811 the separate insns. */
36a05131
BS
4812
4813rtx
f2206911 4814frv_split_scc (rtx dest, rtx test, rtx cc_reg, rtx cr_reg, HOST_WIDE_INT value)
36a05131
BS
4815{
4816 rtx ret;
4817
4818 start_sequence ();
4819
4820 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
4821 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
4822 cr_reg,
4823 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test),
4824 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4825 cc_reg,
4826 const0_rtx)));
4827
4828 /* Move the value into the destination. */
4829 emit_move_insn (dest, GEN_INT (value));
4830
4831 /* Move 0 into the destination if the test failed */
4832 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4833 gen_rtx_EQ (GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4834 cr_reg,
4835 const0_rtx),
4836 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, const0_rtx)));
4837
4838 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
4839 ret = get_insns ();
4840 end_sequence ();
4841 return ret;
4842}
4843
4844\f
4845/* Emit the code for a conditional move, return TRUE if we could do the
4846 move. */
4847
4848int
f2206911 4849frv_emit_cond_move (rtx dest, rtx test_rtx, rtx src1, rtx src2)
36a05131
BS
4850{
4851 rtx set;
4852 rtx clobber_cc;
4853 rtx test2;
4854 rtx cr_reg;
4855 rtx if_rtx;
4856 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (test_rtx);
f90b7a5a
PB
4857 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test,
4858 XEXP (test_rtx, 0), XEXP (test_rtx, 1));
36a05131
BS
4859 enum machine_mode cc_mode = GET_MODE (cc_reg);
4860
4861 /* Conditional move instructions generate:
4862 (parallel [(set <target>
4863 (if_then_else (<test> <cc_reg> (const_int 0))
4864 <src1>
4865 <src2>))
4866 (clobber (<ccr_reg>))]) */
4867
4868 /* Handle various cases of conditional move involving two constants. */
4869 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT)
4870 {
4871 HOST_WIDE_INT value1 = INTVAL (src1);
4872 HOST_WIDE_INT value2 = INTVAL (src2);
4873
87b483a1 4874 /* Having 0 as one of the constants can be done by loading the other
36a05131
BS
4875 constant, and optionally moving in gr0. */
4876 if (value1 == 0 || value2 == 0)
4877 ;
4878
4879 /* If the first value is within an addi range and also the difference
4880 between the two fits in an addi's range, load up the difference, then
4881 conditionally move in 0, and then unconditionally add the first
4882 value. */
2f5b1308
JR
4883 else if (IN_RANGE (value1, -2048, 2047)
4884 && IN_RANGE (value2 - value1, -2048, 2047))
36a05131
BS
4885 ;
4886
4887 /* If neither condition holds, just force the constant into a
4888 register. */
4889 else
4890 {
4891 src1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src1);
4892 src2 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src2);
4893 }
4894 }
4895
4896 /* If one value is a register, insure the other value is either 0 or a
4897 register. */
4898 else
4899 {
4900 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src1) != 0)
4901 src1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src1);
4902
4903 if (GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src2) != 0)
4904 src2 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src2);
4905 }
4906
4907 test2 = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, cc_mode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4908 if_rtx = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (GET_MODE (dest), test2, src1, src2);
4909
4910 set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, if_rtx);
4911
4912 cr_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4913 ? gen_reg_rtx (CC_CCRmode)
4914 : gen_rtx_REG (CC_CCRmode,
4915 (cc_mode == CC_FPmode) ? FCR_FIRST : ICR_FIRST));
4916
4917 clobber_cc = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, cr_reg);
4918 emit_insn (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, set, clobber_cc)));
4919 return TRUE;
4920}
4921
4922\f
839a4992 4923/* Split a conditional move into constituent parts, returning a SEQUENCE
36a05131
BS
4924 containing all of the insns. */
4925
4926rtx
f2206911 4927frv_split_cond_move (rtx operands[])
36a05131
BS
4928{
4929 rtx dest = operands[0];
4930 rtx test = operands[1];
4931 rtx cc_reg = operands[2];
4932 rtx src1 = operands[3];
4933 rtx src2 = operands[4];
4934 rtx cr_reg = operands[5];
4935 rtx ret;
4936 enum machine_mode cr_mode = GET_MODE (cr_reg);
4937
4938 start_sequence ();
4939
4940 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
4941 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
4942 cr_reg,
4943 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test),
4944 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4945 cc_reg,
4946 const0_rtx)));
4947
4948 /* Handle various cases of conditional move involving two constants. */
4949 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT)
4950 {
4951 HOST_WIDE_INT value1 = INTVAL (src1);
4952 HOST_WIDE_INT value2 = INTVAL (src2);
4953
87b483a1 4954 /* Having 0 as one of the constants can be done by loading the other
36a05131
BS
4955 constant, and optionally moving in gr0. */
4956 if (value1 == 0)
4957 {
4958 emit_move_insn (dest, src2);
4959 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4960 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4961 const0_rtx),
4962 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
4963 }
4964
4965 else if (value2 == 0)
4966 {
4967 emit_move_insn (dest, src1);
4968 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4969 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4970 const0_rtx),
4971 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
4972 }
4973
4974 /* If the first value is within an addi range and also the difference
4975 between the two fits in an addi's range, load up the difference, then
4976 conditionally move in 0, and then unconditionally add the first
4977 value. */
2f5b1308
JR
4978 else if (IN_RANGE (value1, -2048, 2047)
4979 && IN_RANGE (value2 - value1, -2048, 2047))
36a05131
BS
4980 {
4981 rtx dest_si = ((GET_MODE (dest) == SImode)
4982 ? dest
4983 : gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, dest, 0));
4984
4985 emit_move_insn (dest_si, GEN_INT (value2 - value1));
4986 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4987 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4988 const0_rtx),
4989 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_si,
4990 const0_rtx)));
4991 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (dest_si, dest_si, src1));
4992 }
4993
4994 else
44e91694 4995 gcc_unreachable ();
36a05131
BS
4996 }
4997 else
4998 {
4999 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being true if needed. */
5000 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src1))
5001 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5002 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5003 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5004
5005 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5006 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src2))
5007 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5008 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5009 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
5010 }
5011
5012 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5013 ret = get_insns ();
5014 end_sequence ();
5015 return ret;
5016}
5017
5018\f
5019/* Split (set DEST SOURCE), where DEST is a double register and SOURCE is a
5020 memory location that is not known to be dword-aligned. */
5021void
f2206911 5022frv_split_double_load (rtx dest, rtx source)
36a05131
BS
5023{
5024 int regno = REGNO (dest);
5025 rtx dest1 = gen_highpart (SImode, dest);
5026 rtx dest2 = gen_lowpart (SImode, dest);
5027 rtx address = XEXP (source, 0);
5028
5029 /* If the address is pre-modified, load the lower-numbered register
5030 first, then load the other register using an integer offset from
5031 the modified base register. This order should always be safe,
5032 since the pre-modification cannot affect the same registers as the
5033 load does.
5034
5035 The situation for other loads is more complicated. Loading one
5036 of the registers could affect the value of ADDRESS, so we must
5037 be careful which order we do them in. */
5038 if (GET_CODE (address) == PRE_MODIFY
5039 || ! refers_to_regno_p (regno, regno + 1, address, NULL))
5040 {
5041 /* It is safe to load the lower-numbered register first. */
5042 emit_move_insn (dest1, change_address (source, SImode, NULL));
5043 emit_move_insn (dest2, frv_index_memory (source, SImode, 1));
5044 }
5045 else
5046 {
5047 /* ADDRESS is not pre-modified and the address depends on the
5048 lower-numbered register. Load the higher-numbered register
5049 first. */
5050 emit_move_insn (dest2, frv_index_memory (source, SImode, 1));
5051 emit_move_insn (dest1, change_address (source, SImode, NULL));
5052 }
5053}
5054
5055/* Split (set DEST SOURCE), where DEST refers to a dword memory location
5056 and SOURCE is either a double register or the constant zero. */
5057void
f2206911 5058frv_split_double_store (rtx dest, rtx source)
36a05131
BS
5059{
5060 rtx dest1 = change_address (dest, SImode, NULL);
5061 rtx dest2 = frv_index_memory (dest, SImode, 1);
5062 if (ZERO_P (source))
5063 {
5064 emit_move_insn (dest1, CONST0_RTX (SImode));
5065 emit_move_insn (dest2, CONST0_RTX (SImode));
5066 }
5067 else
5068 {
5069 emit_move_insn (dest1, gen_highpart (SImode, source));
5070 emit_move_insn (dest2, gen_lowpart (SImode, source));
5071 }
5072}
5073
5074\f
5075/* Split a min/max operation returning a SEQUENCE containing all of the
5076 insns. */
5077
5078rtx
f2206911 5079frv_split_minmax (rtx operands[])
36a05131
BS
5080{
5081 rtx dest = operands[0];
5082 rtx minmax = operands[1];
5083 rtx src1 = operands[2];
5084 rtx src2 = operands[3];
5085 rtx cc_reg = operands[4];
5086 rtx cr_reg = operands[5];
5087 rtx ret;
5088 enum rtx_code test_code;
5089 enum machine_mode cr_mode = GET_MODE (cr_reg);
5090
5091 start_sequence ();
5092
87b483a1 5093 /* Figure out which test to use. */
36a05131
BS
5094 switch (GET_CODE (minmax))
5095 {
5096 default:
44e91694 5097 gcc_unreachable ();
36a05131
BS
5098
5099 case SMIN: test_code = LT; break;
5100 case SMAX: test_code = GT; break;
5101 case UMIN: test_code = LTU; break;
5102 case UMAX: test_code = GTU; break;
5103 }
5104
5105 /* Issue the compare instruction. */
5106 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5107 cc_reg,
5108 gen_rtx_COMPARE (GET_MODE (cc_reg),
5109 src1, src2)));
5110
5111 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
5112 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5113 cr_reg,
5114 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test_code,
5115 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
5116 cc_reg,
5117 const0_rtx)));
5118
9cd10576 5119 /* If are taking the min/max of a nonzero constant, load that first, and
36a05131
BS
5120 then do a conditional move of the other value. */
5121 if (GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src2) != 0)
5122 {
44e91694 5123 gcc_assert (!rtx_equal_p (dest, src1));
36a05131
BS
5124
5125 emit_move_insn (dest, src2);
5126 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5127 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5128 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5129 }
5130
5131 /* Otherwise, do each half of the move. */
5132 else
5133 {
5134 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being true if needed. */
5135 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src1))
5136 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5137 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5138 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5139
5140 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5141 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src2))
5142 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5143 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5144 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
5145 }
5146
5147 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5148 ret = get_insns ();
5149 end_sequence ();
5150 return ret;
5151}
5152
5153\f
5154/* Split an integer abs operation returning a SEQUENCE containing all of the
5155 insns. */
5156
5157rtx
f2206911 5158frv_split_abs (rtx operands[])
36a05131
BS
5159{
5160 rtx dest = operands[0];
5161 rtx src = operands[1];
5162 rtx cc_reg = operands[2];
5163 rtx cr_reg = operands[3];
5164 rtx ret;
5165
5166 start_sequence ();
5167
5168 /* Issue the compare < 0 instruction. */
5169 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5170 cc_reg,
5171 gen_rtx_COMPARE (CCmode, src, const0_rtx)));
5172
5173 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
5174 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5175 cr_reg,
5176 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (LT, CC_CCRmode, cc_reg, const0_rtx)));
5177
87b483a1 5178 /* Emit the conditional negate if the value is negative. */
36a05131
BS
5179 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5180 gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5181 gen_negsi2 (dest, src)));
5182
5183 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5184 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src))
5185 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5186 gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5187 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src)));
5188
5189 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5190 ret = get_insns ();
5191 end_sequence ();
5192 return ret;
5193}
5194
5195\f
5196/* An internal function called by for_each_rtx to clear in a hard_reg set each
5197 register used in an insn. */
5198
5199static int
f2206911 5200frv_clear_registers_used (rtx *ptr, void *data)
36a05131
BS
5201{
5202 if (GET_CODE (*ptr) == REG)
5203 {
5204 int regno = REGNO (*ptr);
5205 HARD_REG_SET *p_regs = (HARD_REG_SET *)data;
5206
5207 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5208 {
5209 int reg_max = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (*ptr));
5210
5211 while (regno < reg_max)
5212 {
5213 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*p_regs, regno);
5214 regno++;
5215 }
5216 }
5217 }
5218
5219 return 0;
5220}
5221
5222\f
5223/* Initialize the extra fields provided by IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS. */
5224
5225/* On the FR-V, we don't have any extra fields per se, but it is useful hook to
5226 initialize the static storage. */
5227void
f2206911 5228frv_ifcvt_init_extra_fields (ce_if_block_t *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131
BS
5229{
5230 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
5231 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
5232 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec = 0;
5233 frv_ifcvt.cr_reg = NULL_RTX;
5234 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg = NULL_RTX;
5235 frv_ifcvt.extra_int_cr = NULL_RTX;
5236 frv_ifcvt.extra_fp_cr = NULL_RTX;
5237 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = NULL_RTX;
5238}
5239
5240\f
1ae58c30 5241/* Internal function to add a potential insn to the list of insns to be inserted
36a05131
BS
5242 if the conditional execution conversion is successful. */
5243
5244static void
f2206911 5245frv_ifcvt_add_insn (rtx pattern, rtx insn, int before_p)
36a05131
BS
5246{
5247 rtx link = alloc_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, pattern, insn);
5248
87b483a1 5249 link->jump = before_p; /* Mark to add this before or after insn. */
36a05131
BS
5250 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = alloc_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, link,
5251 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list);
5252
5253 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5254 {
5255 fprintf (stderr,
5256 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_add_insn: add the following %s insn %d:\n",
5257 (before_p) ? "before" : "after",
5258 (int)INSN_UID (insn));
5259
5260 debug_rtx (pattern);
5261 }
5262}
5263
5264\f
5265/* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5266 information CE_INFO, possibly updating the tests in TRUE_EXPR, and
5267 FALSE_EXPR for converting if-then and if-then-else code to conditional
5268 instructions. Set either TRUE_EXPR or FALSE_EXPR to a null pointer if the
5269 tests cannot be converted. */
5270
5271void
f2206911 5272frv_ifcvt_modify_tests (ce_if_block_t *ce_info, rtx *p_true, rtx *p_false)
36a05131
BS
5273{
5274 basic_block test_bb = ce_info->test_bb; /* test basic block */
5275 basic_block then_bb = ce_info->then_bb; /* THEN */
5276 basic_block else_bb = ce_info->else_bb; /* ELSE or NULL */
5277 basic_block join_bb = ce_info->join_bb; /* join block or NULL */
5278 rtx true_expr = *p_true;
5279 rtx cr;
5280 rtx cc;
5281 rtx nested_cc;
5282 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (true_expr);
5283 int j;
5284 basic_block *bb;
5285 int num_bb;
5286 frv_tmp_reg_t *tmp_reg = &frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg;
5287 rtx check_insn;
5288 rtx sub_cond_exec_reg;
5289 enum rtx_code code;
5290 enum rtx_code code_true;
5291 enum rtx_code code_false;
5292 enum reg_class cc_class;
5293 enum reg_class cr_class;
5294 int cc_first;
5295 int cc_last;
a2041967 5296 reg_set_iterator rsi;
36a05131
BS
5297
5298 /* Make sure we are only dealing with hard registers. Also honor the
5299 -mno-cond-exec switch, and -mno-nested-cond-exec switches if
5300 applicable. */
0b2c18fe
RS
5301 if (!reload_completed || !TARGET_COND_EXEC
5302 || (!TARGET_NESTED_CE && ce_info->pass > 1))
36a05131
BS
5303 goto fail;
5304
5305 /* Figure out which registers we can allocate for our own purposes. Only
5306 consider registers that are not preserved across function calls and are
5307 not fixed. However, allow the ICC/ICR temporary registers to be allocated
87b483a1 5308 if we did not need to use them in reloading other registers. */
fad205ff 5309 memset (&tmp_reg->regs, 0, sizeof (tmp_reg->regs));
36a05131
BS
5310 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (tmp_reg->regs, call_used_reg_set);
5311 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (tmp_reg->regs, fixed_reg_set);
5312 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, ICC_TEMP);
5313 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, ICR_TEMP);
5314
5315 /* If this is a nested IF, we need to discover whether the CC registers that
5316 are set/used inside of the block are used anywhere else. If not, we can
5317 change them to be the CC register that is paired with the CR register that
5318 controls the outermost IF block. */
5319 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5320 {
5321 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite);
5322 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5323 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5324 {
eedd7243 5325 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (then_bb), j))
36a05131
BS
5326 continue;
5327
5e2d947c 5328 if (else_bb
eedd7243 5329 && REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (else_bb), j))
36a05131
BS
5330 continue;
5331
5e2d947c 5332 if (join_bb
eedd7243 5333 && REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (join_bb), j))
36a05131
BS
5334 continue;
5335
5336 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, j);
5337 }
5338 }
5339
5340 for (j = 0; j < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; j++)
5341 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[j] = NULL_RTX;
5342
5343 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
5344 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
5345
5346 bb = (basic_block *) alloca ((2 + ce_info->num_multiple_test_blocks)
5347 * sizeof (basic_block));
5348
5349 if (join_bb)
5350 {
38c28a25 5351 unsigned int regno;
36a05131
BS
5352
5353 /* Remove anything live at the beginning of the join block from being
5354 available for allocation. */
eedd7243 5355 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (df_get_live_in (join_bb), 0, regno, rsi)
a2041967
KH
5356 {
5357 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5358 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, regno);
5359 }
36a05131
BS
5360 }
5361
5362 /* Add in all of the blocks in multiple &&/|| blocks to be scanned. */
5363 num_bb = 0;
5364 if (ce_info->num_multiple_test_blocks)
5365 {
5366 basic_block multiple_test_bb = ce_info->last_test_bb;
5367
5368 while (multiple_test_bb != test_bb)
5369 {
5370 bb[num_bb++] = multiple_test_bb;
628f6a4e 5371 multiple_test_bb = EDGE_PRED (multiple_test_bb, 0)->src;
36a05131
BS
5372 }
5373 }
5374
5375 /* Add in the THEN and ELSE blocks to be scanned. */
5376 bb[num_bb++] = then_bb;
5377 if (else_bb)
5378 bb[num_bb++] = else_bb;
5379
5380 sub_cond_exec_reg = NULL_RTX;
5381 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec = 0;
5382
5383 /* Scan all of the blocks for registers that must not be allocated. */
5384 for (j = 0; j < num_bb; j++)
5385 {
a813c111
SB
5386 rtx last_insn = BB_END (bb[j]);
5387 rtx insn = BB_HEAD (bb[j]);
38c28a25 5388 unsigned int regno;
36a05131 5389
c263766c
RH
5390 if (dump_file)
5391 fprintf (dump_file, "Scanning %s block %d, start %d, end %d\n",
36a05131
BS
5392 (bb[j] == else_bb) ? "else" : ((bb[j] == then_bb) ? "then" : "test"),
5393 (int) bb[j]->index,
a813c111
SB
5394 (int) INSN_UID (BB_HEAD (bb[j])),
5395 (int) INSN_UID (BB_END (bb[j])));
36a05131
BS
5396
5397 /* Anything live at the beginning of the block is obviously unavailable
5398 for allocation. */
eedd7243 5399 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (df_get_live_in (bb[j]), 0, regno, rsi)
a2041967
KH
5400 {
5401 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5402 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, regno);
5403 }
36a05131 5404
87b483a1 5405 /* Loop through the insns in the block. */
36a05131
BS
5406 for (;;)
5407 {
5408 /* Mark any new registers that are created as being unavailable for
5409 allocation. Also see if the CC register used in nested IFs can be
5410 reallocated. */
5411 if (INSN_P (insn))
5412 {
5413 rtx pattern;
5414 rtx set;
5415 int skip_nested_if = FALSE;
5416
5417 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_clear_registers_used,
5418 (void *)&tmp_reg->regs);
5419
5420 pattern = PATTERN (insn);
5421 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC)
5422 {
5423 rtx reg = XEXP (COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern), 0);
5424
5425 if (reg != sub_cond_exec_reg)
5426 {
5427 sub_cond_exec_reg = reg;
5428 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec++;
5429 }
5430 }
5431
5432 set = single_set_pattern (pattern);
5433 if (set)
5434 {
5435 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
5436 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
5437
5438 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
5439 {
5440 int regno = REGNO (dest);
5441 enum rtx_code src_code = GET_CODE (src);
5442
5443 if (CC_P (regno) && src_code == COMPARE)
5444 skip_nested_if = TRUE;
5445
5446 else if (CR_P (regno)
5447 && (src_code == IF_THEN_ELSE
ec8e098d 5448 || COMPARISON_P (src)))
36a05131
BS
5449 skip_nested_if = TRUE;
5450 }
5451 }
5452
5453 if (! skip_nested_if)
5454 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_clear_registers_used,
5455 (void *)&frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite);
5456 }
5457
5458 if (insn == last_insn)
5459 break;
5460
5461 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
5462 }
5463 }
5464
5465 /* If this is a nested if, rewrite the CC registers that are available to
5466 include the ones that can be rewritten, to increase the chance of being
5467 able to allocate a paired CC/CR register combination. */
5468 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5469 {
5470 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5471 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, j))
5472 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j);
5473 else
5474 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j);
5475 }
5476
c263766c 5477 if (dump_file)
36a05131
BS
5478 {
5479 int num_gprs = 0;
c263766c 5480 fprintf (dump_file, "Available GPRs: ");
36a05131
BS
5481
5482 for (j = GPR_FIRST; j <= GPR_LAST; j++)
5483 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5484 {
c263766c 5485 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
36a05131
BS
5486 if (++num_gprs > GPR_TEMP_NUM+2)
5487 break;
5488 }
5489
c263766c 5490 fprintf (dump_file, "%s\nAvailable CRs: ",
36a05131
BS
5491 (num_gprs > GPR_TEMP_NUM+2) ? " ..." : "");
5492
5493 for (j = CR_FIRST; j <= CR_LAST; j++)
5494 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
c263766c 5495 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
36a05131 5496
c263766c 5497 fputs ("\n", dump_file);
36a05131
BS
5498
5499 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5500 {
c263766c 5501 fprintf (dump_file, "Modifiable CCs: ");
36a05131
BS
5502 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5503 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
c263766c 5504 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
36a05131 5505
c263766c 5506 fprintf (dump_file, "\n%d nested COND_EXEC statements\n",
36a05131
BS
5507 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec);
5508 }
5509 }
5510
5511 /* Allocate the appropriate temporary condition code register. Try to
5512 allocate the ICR/FCR register that corresponds to the ICC/FCC register so
5513 that conditional cmp's can be done. */
036ff63f 5514 if (mode == CCmode || mode == CC_UNSmode || mode == CC_NZmode)
36a05131
BS
5515 {
5516 cr_class = ICR_REGS;
5517 cc_class = ICC_REGS;
5518 cc_first = ICC_FIRST;
5519 cc_last = ICC_LAST;
5520 }
5521 else if (mode == CC_FPmode)
5522 {
5523 cr_class = FCR_REGS;
5524 cc_class = FCC_REGS;
5525 cc_first = FCC_FIRST;
5526 cc_last = FCC_LAST;
5527 }
5528 else
5529 {
5530 cc_first = cc_last = 0;
5531 cr_class = cc_class = NO_REGS;
5532 }
5533
5534 cc = XEXP (true_expr, 0);
5535 nested_cc = cr = NULL_RTX;
5536 if (cc_class != NO_REGS)
5537 {
5538 /* For nested IFs and &&/||, see if we can find a CC and CR register pair
5539 so we can execute a csubcc/caddcc/cfcmps instruction. */
5540 int cc_regno;
5541
5542 for (cc_regno = cc_first; cc_regno <= cc_last; cc_regno++)
5543 {
5544 int cr_regno = cc_regno - CC_FIRST + CR_FIRST;
5545
5546 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, cc_regno)
5547 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, cr_regno))
5548 {
5549 frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.next_reg[ (int)cr_class ] = cr_regno;
5550 cr = frv_alloc_temp_reg (tmp_reg, cr_class, CC_CCRmode, TRUE,
5551 TRUE);
5552
5553 frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.next_reg[ (int)cc_class ] = cc_regno;
5554 nested_cc = frv_alloc_temp_reg (tmp_reg, cc_class, CCmode,
5555 TRUE, TRUE);
5556 break;
5557 }
5558 }
5559 }
5560
5561 if (! cr)
5562 {
c263766c
RH
5563 if (dump_file)
5564 fprintf (dump_file, "Could not allocate a CR temporary register\n");
36a05131
BS
5565
5566 goto fail;
5567 }
5568
c263766c
RH
5569 if (dump_file)
5570 fprintf (dump_file,
36a05131
BS
5571 "Will use %s for conditional execution, %s for nested comparisons\n",
5572 reg_names[ REGNO (cr)],
5573 (nested_cc) ? reg_names[ REGNO (nested_cc) ] : "<none>");
5574
5575 /* Set the CCR bit. Note for integer tests, we reverse the condition so that
5576 in an IF-THEN-ELSE sequence, we are testing the TRUE case against the CCR
5577 bit being true. We don't do this for floating point, because of NaNs. */
5578 code = GET_CODE (true_expr);
5579 if (GET_MODE (cc) != CC_FPmode)
5580 {
5581 code = reverse_condition (code);
5582 code_true = EQ;
5583 code_false = NE;
5584 }
5585 else
5586 {
5587 code_true = NE;
5588 code_false = EQ;
5589 }
5590
5591 check_insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cr,
5592 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, CC_CCRmode, cc, const0_rtx));
5593
5594 /* Record the check insn to be inserted later. */
a813c111 5595 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (check_insn, BB_END (test_bb), TRUE);
36a05131
BS
5596
5597 /* Update the tests. */
5598 frv_ifcvt.cr_reg = cr;
5599 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg = nested_cc;
5600 *p_true = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code_true, CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5601 *p_false = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code_false, CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5602 return;
5603
5604 /* Fail, don't do this conditional execution. */
5605 fail:
5606 *p_true = NULL_RTX;
5607 *p_false = NULL_RTX;
c263766c
RH
5608 if (dump_file)
5609 fprintf (dump_file, "Disabling this conditional execution.\n");
36a05131
BS
5610
5611 return;
5612}
5613
5614\f
5615/* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5616 information CE_INFO, for the basic block BB, possibly updating the tests in
5617 TRUE_EXPR, and FALSE_EXPR for converting the && and || parts of if-then or
5618 if-then-else code to conditional instructions. Set either TRUE_EXPR or
5619 FALSE_EXPR to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted. */
5620
5621/* p_true and p_false are given expressions of the form:
5622
5623 (and (eq:CC_CCR (reg:CC_CCR)
5624 (const_int 0))
5625 (eq:CC (reg:CC)
5626 (const_int 0))) */
5627
5628void
f2206911
KC
5629frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests (ce_if_block_t *ce_info,
5630 basic_block bb,
5631 rtx *p_true,
5632 rtx *p_false)
36a05131
BS
5633{
5634 rtx old_true = XEXP (*p_true, 0);
5635 rtx old_false = XEXP (*p_false, 0);
5636 rtx true_expr = XEXP (*p_true, 1);
5637 rtx false_expr = XEXP (*p_false, 1);
5638 rtx test_expr;
5639 rtx old_test;
5640 rtx cr = XEXP (old_true, 0);
5641 rtx check_insn;
5642 rtx new_cr = NULL_RTX;
5643 rtx *p_new_cr = (rtx *)0;
5644 rtx if_else;
5645 rtx compare;
5646 rtx cc;
5647 enum reg_class cr_class;
5648 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (true_expr);
5649 rtx (*logical_func)(rtx, rtx, rtx);
5650
5651 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5652 {
5653 fprintf (stderr,
5654 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, before modification for %s\ntrue insn:\n",
5655 ce_info->and_and_p ? "&&" : "||");
5656
5657 debug_rtx (*p_true);
5658
5659 fputs ("\nfalse insn:\n", stderr);
5660 debug_rtx (*p_false);
5661 }
5662
0b2c18fe 5663 if (!TARGET_MULTI_CE)
36a05131
BS
5664 goto fail;
5665
5666 if (GET_CODE (cr) != REG)
5667 goto fail;
b16c1435 5668
036ff63f 5669 if (mode == CCmode || mode == CC_UNSmode || mode == CC_NZmode)
36a05131
BS
5670 {
5671 cr_class = ICR_REGS;
5672 p_new_cr = &frv_ifcvt.extra_int_cr;
5673 }
5674 else if (mode == CC_FPmode)
5675 {
5676 cr_class = FCR_REGS;
5677 p_new_cr = &frv_ifcvt.extra_fp_cr;
5678 }
5679 else
5680 goto fail;
5681
5682 /* Allocate a temp CR, reusing a previously allocated temp CR if we have 3 or
5683 more &&/|| tests. */
5684 new_cr = *p_new_cr;
5685 if (! new_cr)
5686 {
5687 new_cr = *p_new_cr = frv_alloc_temp_reg (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, cr_class,
5688 CC_CCRmode, TRUE, TRUE);
5689 if (! new_cr)
5690 goto fail;
5691 }
5692
5693 if (ce_info->and_and_p)
5694 {
5695 old_test = old_false;
5696 test_expr = true_expr;
5697 logical_func = (GET_CODE (old_true) == EQ) ? gen_andcr : gen_andncr;
5698 *p_true = gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5699 *p_false = gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5700 }
5701 else
5702 {
5703 old_test = old_false;
5704 test_expr = false_expr;
5705 logical_func = (GET_CODE (old_false) == EQ) ? gen_orcr : gen_orncr;
5706 *p_true = gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5707 *p_false = gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5708 }
5709
5710 /* First add the andcr/andncr/orcr/orncr, which will be added after the
5711 conditional check instruction, due to frv_ifcvt_add_insn being a LIFO
5712 stack. */
a813c111 5713 frv_ifcvt_add_insn ((*logical_func) (cr, cr, new_cr), BB_END (bb), TRUE);
36a05131
BS
5714
5715 /* Now add the conditional check insn. */
5716 cc = XEXP (test_expr, 0);
5717 compare = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test_expr), CC_CCRmode, cc, const0_rtx);
5718 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (CC_CCRmode, old_test, compare, const0_rtx);
5719
5720 check_insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new_cr, if_else);
5721
87b483a1 5722 /* Add the new check insn to the list of check insns that need to be
36a05131 5723 inserted. */
a813c111 5724 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (check_insn, BB_END (bb), TRUE);
36a05131
BS
5725
5726 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5727 {
5728 fputs ("\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, after modification\ntrue insn:\n",
5729 stderr);
5730
5731 debug_rtx (*p_true);
5732
5733 fputs ("\nfalse insn:\n", stderr);
5734 debug_rtx (*p_false);
5735 }
5736
5737 return;
5738
5739 fail:
5740 *p_true = *p_false = NULL_RTX;
5741
87b483a1 5742 /* If we allocated a CR register, release it. */
36a05131
BS
5743 if (new_cr)
5744 {
5745 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, REGNO (new_cr));
5746 *p_new_cr = NULL_RTX;
5747 }
5748
5749 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5750 fputs ("\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, failed.\n", stderr);
5751
5752 return;
5753}
5754
5755\f
5756/* Return a register which will be loaded with a value if an IF block is
5757 converted to conditional execution. This is used to rewrite instructions
5758 that use constants to ones that just use registers. */
5759
5760static rtx
f2206911 5761frv_ifcvt_load_value (rtx value, rtx insn ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131
BS
5762{
5763 int num_alloc = frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs;
5764 int i;
5765 rtx reg;
5766
5767 /* We know gr0 == 0, so replace any errant uses. */
5768 if (value == const0_rtx)
5769 return gen_rtx_REG (SImode, GPR_FIRST);
5770
5771 /* First search all registers currently loaded to see if we have an
5772 applicable constant. */
5773 if (CONSTANT_P (value)
5774 || (GET_CODE (value) == REG && REGNO (value) == LR_REGNO))
5775 {
5776 for (i = 0; i < num_alloc; i++)
5777 {
5778 if (rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i]), value))
5779 return SET_DEST (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i]);
5780 }
5781 }
5782
87b483a1 5783 /* Have we exhausted the number of registers available? */
36a05131
BS
5784 if (num_alloc >= GPR_TEMP_NUM)
5785 {
c263766c
RH
5786 if (dump_file)
5787 fprintf (dump_file, "Too many temporary registers allocated\n");
36a05131
BS
5788
5789 return NULL_RTX;
5790 }
5791
5792 /* Allocate the new register. */
5793 reg = frv_alloc_temp_reg (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, GPR_REGS, SImode, TRUE, TRUE);
5794 if (! reg)
5795 {
c263766c
RH
5796 if (dump_file)
5797 fputs ("Could not find a scratch register\n", dump_file);
36a05131
BS
5798
5799 return NULL_RTX;
5800 }
5801
5802 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs++;
5803 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[num_alloc] = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, value);
5804
c263766c 5805 if (dump_file)
36a05131
BS
5806 {
5807 if (GET_CODE (value) == CONST_INT)
c263766c 5808 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold %ld\n",
36a05131
BS
5809 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)], (long)INTVAL (value));
5810
5811 else if (GET_CODE (value) == REG && REGNO (value) == LR_REGNO)
c263766c 5812 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold LR\n",
36a05131
BS
5813 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)]);
5814
5815 else
c263766c 5816 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold a saved value\n",
36a05131
BS
5817 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)]);
5818 }
5819
5820 return reg;
5821}
5822
5823\f
5824/* Update a MEM used in conditional code that might contain an offset to put
5825 the offset into a scratch register, so that the conditional load/store
5826 operations can be used. This function returns the original pointer if the
5827 MEM is valid to use in conditional code, NULL if we can't load up the offset
5828 into a temporary register, or the new MEM if we were successful. */
5829
5830static rtx
f2206911 5831frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (rtx mem, enum machine_mode mode, rtx insn)
36a05131
BS
5832{
5833 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
5834
c6c3dba9 5835 if (!frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, addr, reload_completed, TRUE, FALSE))
36a05131
BS
5836 {
5837 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS)
5838 {
5839 rtx addr_op0 = XEXP (addr, 0);
5840 rtx addr_op1 = XEXP (addr, 1);
5841
34208acf 5842 if (GET_CODE (addr_op0) == REG && CONSTANT_P (addr_op1))
36a05131
BS
5843 {
5844 rtx reg = frv_ifcvt_load_value (addr_op1, insn);
5845 if (!reg)
5846 return NULL_RTX;
5847
5848 addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, addr_op0, reg);
5849 }
5850
5851 else
5852 return NULL_RTX;
5853 }
5854
5855 else if (CONSTANT_P (addr))
5856 addr = frv_ifcvt_load_value (addr, insn);
5857
5858 else
5859 return NULL_RTX;
5860
5861 if (addr == NULL_RTX)
5862 return NULL_RTX;
5863
5864 else if (XEXP (mem, 0) != addr)
5865 return change_address (mem, mode, addr);
5866 }
5867
5868 return mem;
5869}
5870
5871\f
5872/* Given a PATTERN, return a SET expression if this PATTERN has only a single
5873 SET, possibly conditionally executed. It may also have CLOBBERs, USEs. */
5874
5875static rtx
f2206911 5876single_set_pattern (rtx pattern)
36a05131
BS
5877{
5878 rtx set;
5879 int i;
5880
5881 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC)
5882 pattern = COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern);
5883
5884 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET)
5885 return pattern;
5886
5887 else if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL)
5888 {
5889 for (i = 0, set = 0; i < XVECLEN (pattern, 0); i++)
5890 {
5891 rtx sub = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i);
5892
5893 switch (GET_CODE (sub))
5894 {
5895 case USE:
5896 case CLOBBER:
5897 break;
5898
5899 case SET:
5900 if (set)
5901 return 0;
5902 else
5903 set = sub;
5904 break;
5905
5906 default:
5907 return 0;
5908 }
5909 }
5910 return set;
5911 }
5912
5913 return 0;
5914}
5915
5916\f
5917/* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5918 information CE_INFO with the new PATTERN in INSN. If PATTERN is a null
5919 pointer after the IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN macro executes, it is assumed that that
5920 insn cannot be converted to be executed conditionally. */
5921
5922rtx
5da1fd3d 5923frv_ifcvt_modify_insn (ce_if_block_t *ce_info,
f2206911
KC
5924 rtx pattern,
5925 rtx insn)
36a05131
BS
5926{
5927 rtx orig_ce_pattern = pattern;
5928 rtx set;
5929 rtx op0;
5930 rtx op1;
5931 rtx test;
5932
44e91694 5933 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC);
36a05131
BS
5934
5935 test = COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern);
5936 if (GET_CODE (test) == AND)
5937 {
5938 rtx cr = frv_ifcvt.cr_reg;
5939 rtx test_reg;
5940
5941 op0 = XEXP (test, 0);
5942 if (! rtx_equal_p (cr, XEXP (op0, 0)))
5943 goto fail;
5944
5945 op1 = XEXP (test, 1);
5946 test_reg = XEXP (op1, 0);
5947 if (GET_CODE (test_reg) != REG)
5948 goto fail;
5949
5950 /* Is this the first nested if block in this sequence? If so, generate
5951 an andcr or andncr. */
5952 if (! frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr)
5953 {
5954 rtx and_op;
5955
5956 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = test_reg;
5957 if (GET_CODE (op0) == NE)
5958 and_op = gen_andcr (test_reg, cr, test_reg);
5959 else
5960 and_op = gen_andncr (test_reg, cr, test_reg);
5961
5962 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (and_op, insn, TRUE);
5963 }
5964
5965 /* If this isn't the first statement in the nested if sequence, see if we
5966 are dealing with the same register. */
5967 else if (! rtx_equal_p (test_reg, frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr))
5968 goto fail;
5969
5970 COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern) = test = op1;
5971 }
5972
5973 /* If this isn't a nested if, reset state variables. */
5974 else
5975 {
5976 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = NULL_RTX;
5977 }
5978
5979 set = single_set_pattern (pattern);
5980 if (set)
5981 {
5982 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
5983 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
5984 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
5985
87b483a1 5986 /* Check for normal binary operators. */
ec8e098d 5987 if (mode == SImode && ARITHMETIC_P (src))
36a05131
BS
5988 {
5989 op0 = XEXP (src, 0);
5990 op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
5991
34208acf 5992 if (integer_register_operand (op0, SImode) && CONSTANT_P (op1))
36a05131
BS
5993 {
5994 op1 = frv_ifcvt_load_value (op1, insn);
5995 if (op1)
5996 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
5997 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (src),
5998 GET_MODE (src),
5999 op0, op1));
6000 else
6001 goto fail;
6002 }
6003 }
6004
6005 /* For multiply by a constant, we need to handle the sign extending
6006 correctly. Add a USE of the value after the multiply to prevent flow
6007 from cratering because only one register out of the two were used. */
6008 else if (mode == DImode && GET_CODE (src) == MULT)
6009 {
6010 op0 = XEXP (src, 0);
6011 op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
6012 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SIGN_EXTEND && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
6013 {
6014 op1 = frv_ifcvt_load_value (op1, insn);
6015 if (op1)
6016 {
6017 op1 = gen_rtx_SIGN_EXTEND (DImode, op1);
6018 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
6019 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest,
6020 gen_rtx_MULT (DImode, op0, op1));
6021 }
6022 else
6023 goto fail;
6024 }
6025
c41c1387 6026 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (gen_use (dest), insn, FALSE);
36a05131
BS
6027 }
6028
6029 /* If we are just loading a constant created for a nested conditional
6030 execution statement, just load the constant without any conditional
6031 execution, since we know that the constant will not interfere with any
6032 other registers. */
6033 else if (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap
6034 && bitmap_bit_p (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap,
5da1fd3d 6035 INSN_UID (insn))
5da1fd3d 6036 && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
9a228f09
AO
6037 /* We must not unconditionally set a scratch reg chosen
6038 for a nested if-converted block if its incoming
6039 value from the TEST block (or the result of the THEN
6040 branch) could/should propagate to the JOIN block.
6041 It suffices to test whether the register is live at
6042 the JOIN point: if it's live there, we can infer
6043 that we set it in the former JOIN block of the
6044 nested if-converted block (otherwise it wouldn't
6045 have been available as a scratch register), and it
6046 is either propagated through or set in the other
6047 conditional block. It's probably not worth trying
6048 to catch the latter case, and it could actually
6049 limit scheduling of the combined block quite
6050 severely. */
6051 && ce_info->join_bb
eedd7243
RIL
6052 && ! (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (ce_info->join_bb),
6053 REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))
9a228f09
AO
6054 /* Similarly, we must not unconditionally set a reg
6055 used as scratch in the THEN branch if the same reg
6056 is live in the ELSE branch. */
5da1fd3d
AO
6057 && (! ce_info->else_bb
6058 || BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn) == ce_info->else_bb
eedd7243
RIL
6059 || ! (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (ce_info->else_bb),
6060 REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))))
36a05131
BS
6061 pattern = set;
6062
6063 else if (mode == QImode || mode == HImode || mode == SImode
6064 || mode == SFmode)
6065 {
6066 int changed_p = FALSE;
6067
6068 /* Check for just loading up a constant */
6069 if (CONSTANT_P (src) && integer_register_operand (dest, mode))
6070 {
6071 src = frv_ifcvt_load_value (src, insn);
6072 if (!src)
6073 goto fail;
6074
6075 changed_p = TRUE;
6076 }
6077
6078 /* See if we need to fix up stores */
6079 if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
6080 {
6081 rtx new_mem = frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (dest, mode, insn);
6082
6083 if (!new_mem)
6084 goto fail;
6085
6086 else if (new_mem != dest)
6087 {
6088 changed_p = TRUE;
6089 dest = new_mem;
6090 }
6091 }
6092
6093 /* See if we need to fix up loads */
6094 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
6095 {
6096 rtx new_mem = frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (src, mode, insn);
6097
6098 if (!new_mem)
6099 goto fail;
6100
6101 else if (new_mem != src)
6102 {
6103 changed_p = TRUE;
6104 src = new_mem;
6105 }
6106 }
6107
6108 /* If either src or destination changed, redo SET. */
6109 if (changed_p)
6110 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern) = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src);
6111 }
6112
6113 /* Rewrite a nested set cccr in terms of IF_THEN_ELSE. Also deal with
6114 rewriting the CC register to be the same as the paired CC/CR register
6115 for nested ifs. */
ec8e098d 6116 else if (mode == CC_CCRmode && COMPARISON_P (src))
36a05131
BS
6117 {
6118 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (src, 0));
6119 rtx if_else;
6120
6121 if (ce_info->pass > 1
6122 && regno != (int)REGNO (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg)
6123 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, regno))
6124 {
6125 src = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (src),
6126 CC_CCRmode,
6127 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg,
6128 XEXP (src, 1));
6129 }
6130
6131 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (CC_CCRmode, test, src, const0_rtx);
6132 pattern = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, if_else);
6133 }
6134
6135 /* Remap a nested compare instruction to use the paired CC/CR reg. */
6136 else if (ce_info->pass > 1
6137 && GET_CODE (dest) == REG
6138 && CC_P (REGNO (dest))
6139 && REGNO (dest) != REGNO (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg)
6140 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite,
6141 REGNO (dest))
6142 && GET_CODE (src) == COMPARE)
6143 {
6144 PUT_MODE (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg, GET_MODE (dest));
6145 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
6146 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg, copy_rtx (src));
6147 }
6148 }
6149
6150 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
6151 {
6152 rtx orig_pattern = PATTERN (insn);
6153
6154 PATTERN (insn) = pattern;
6155 fprintf (stderr,
6156 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_insn: pass = %d, insn after modification:\n",
6157 ce_info->pass);
6158
6159 debug_rtx (insn);
6160 PATTERN (insn) = orig_pattern;
6161 }
6162
6163 return pattern;
6164
6165 fail:
6166 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
6167 {
6168 rtx orig_pattern = PATTERN (insn);
6169
6170 PATTERN (insn) = orig_ce_pattern;
6171 fprintf (stderr,
6172 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_insn: pass = %d, insn could not be modified:\n",
6173 ce_info->pass);
6174
6175 debug_rtx (insn);
6176 PATTERN (insn) = orig_pattern;
6177 }
6178
6179 return NULL_RTX;
6180}
6181
6182\f
6183/* A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
6184 converting code to conditional execution in the code described by the
6185 conditional if information CE_INFO. */
6186
6187void
f2206911 6188frv_ifcvt_modify_final (ce_if_block_t *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131
BS
6189{
6190 rtx existing_insn;
6191 rtx check_insn;
6192 rtx p = frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list;
6193 int i;
6194
6195 /* Loop inserting the check insns. The last check insn is the first test,
6196 and is the appropriate place to insert constants. */
44e91694 6197 gcc_assert (p);
36a05131
BS
6198
6199 do
6200 {
6201 rtx check_and_insert_insns = XEXP (p, 0);
6202 rtx old_p = p;
6203
6204 check_insn = XEXP (check_and_insert_insns, 0);
6205 existing_insn = XEXP (check_and_insert_insns, 1);
6206 p = XEXP (p, 1);
6207
6208 /* The jump bit is used to say that the new insn is to be inserted BEFORE
6209 the existing insn, otherwise it is to be inserted AFTER. */
6210 if (check_and_insert_insns->jump)
6211 {
6212 emit_insn_before (check_insn, existing_insn);
6213 check_and_insert_insns->jump = 0;
6214 }
6215 else
6216 emit_insn_after (check_insn, existing_insn);
6217
6218 free_EXPR_LIST_node (check_and_insert_insns);
6219 free_EXPR_LIST_node (old_p);
6220 }
6221 while (p != NULL_RTX);
6222
6223 /* Load up any constants needed into temp gprs */
6224 for (i = 0; i < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; i++)
6225 {
6226 rtx insn = emit_insn_before (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i], existing_insn);
6227 if (! frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap)
7b210806 6228 frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
36a05131
BS
6229 bitmap_set_bit (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap, INSN_UID (insn));
6230 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i] = NULL_RTX;
6231 }
6232
6233 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
6234 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
6235}
6236
6237\f
6238/* A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in converting
6239 code to conditional execution in the code described by the conditional if
6240 information CE_INFO. */
6241
6242void
f2206911 6243frv_ifcvt_modify_cancel (ce_if_block_t *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131
BS
6244{
6245 int i;
6246 rtx p = frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list;
6247
6248 /* Loop freeing up the EXPR_LIST's allocated. */
6249 while (p != NULL_RTX)
6250 {
6251 rtx check_and_jump = XEXP (p, 0);
6252 rtx old_p = p;
6253
6254 p = XEXP (p, 1);
6255 free_EXPR_LIST_node (check_and_jump);
6256 free_EXPR_LIST_node (old_p);
6257 }
6258
6259 /* Release any temporary gprs allocated. */
6260 for (i = 0; i < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; i++)
6261 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i] = NULL_RTX;
6262
6263 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
6264 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
6265 return;
6266}
6267\f
6268/* A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
6269 The template is:
6270
6271 setlo #0, <jmp_reg>
6272 setlo #0, <static_chain>
6273 sethi #0, <jmp_reg>
6274 sethi #0, <static_chain>
6275 jmpl @(gr0,<jmp_reg>) */
6276
6277int
f2206911 6278frv_trampoline_size (void)
36a05131 6279{
34208acf
AO
6280 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
6281 /* Allocate room for the function descriptor and the lddi
6282 instruction. */
6283 return 8 + 6 * 4;
6284 return 5 /* instructions */ * 4 /* instruction size. */;
36a05131
BS
6285}
6286
6287\f
6288/* A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline. ADDR is an
6289 RTX for the address of the trampoline; FNADDR is an RTX for the address of
6290 the nested function; STATIC_CHAIN is an RTX for the static chain value that
6291 should be passed to the function when it is called.
6292
6293 The template is:
6294
6295 setlo #0, <jmp_reg>
6296 setlo #0, <static_chain>
6297 sethi #0, <jmp_reg>
6298 sethi #0, <static_chain>
6299 jmpl @(gr0,<jmp_reg>) */
6300
e9d5fdb2
RH
6301static void
6302frv_trampoline_init (rtx m_tramp, tree fndecl, rtx static_chain)
36a05131 6303{
e9d5fdb2
RH
6304 rtx addr = XEXP (m_tramp, 0);
6305 rtx fnaddr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (fndecl), 0);
36a05131
BS
6306 rtx sc_reg = force_reg (Pmode, static_chain);
6307
6308 emit_library_call (gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, "__trampoline_setup"),
5c5e8419 6309 LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode, 4,
36a05131
BS
6310 addr, Pmode,
6311 GEN_INT (frv_trampoline_size ()), SImode,
6312 fnaddr, Pmode,
6313 sc_reg, Pmode);
6314}
6315
6316\f
6317/* Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or from
6318 memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the `MQ'
6319 register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or from general
6320 registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all registers to and
6321 from memory, but require a scratch register for stores to some memory
6322 locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT, and those with
981f6289 6323 certain symbolic address on the SPARC when compiling PIC). In some cases,
36a05131
BS
6324 both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
6325
6326 You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
6327 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
6328 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying X to a register
0a2aaacc 6329 RCLASS in MODE requires an intermediate register, you should define
36a05131
BS
6330 `SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS' to return the largest register class all of
6331 whose registers can be used as intermediate registers or scratch registers.
6332
0a2aaacc 6333 If copying a register RCLASS in MODE to X requires an intermediate or scratch
36a05131
BS
6334 register, `SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS' should be defined to return the
6335 largest register class required. If the requirements for input and output
6336 reloads are the same, the macro `SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS' should be used
6337 instead of defining both macros identically.
6338
6339 The values returned by these macros are often `GENERAL_REGS'. Return
6340 `NO_REGS' if no spare register is needed; i.e., if X can be directly copied
0a2aaacc 6341 to or from a register of RCLASS in MODE without requiring a scratch register.
36a05131
BS
6342 Do not define this macro if it would always return `NO_REGS'.
6343
6344 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an intermediate
6345 register), you should define patterns for `reload_inM' or `reload_outM', as
6346 required.. These patterns, which will normally be implemented with a
6347 `define_expand', should be similar to the `movM' patterns, except that
6348 operand 2 is the scratch register.
6349
6350 Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that contain
6351 a single register class. If the original reload register (whose class is
0a2aaacc 6352 RCLASS) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the value returned by
36a05131
BS
6353 these macros is used for the class of the scratch register. Otherwise, two
6354 additional reload registers are required. Their classes are obtained from
6355 the constraints in the insn pattern.
6356
6357 X might be a pseudo-register or a `subreg' of a pseudo-register, which could
6358 either be in a hard register or in memory. Use `true_regnum' to find out;
6359 it will return -1 if the pseudo is in memory and the hard register number if
6360 it is in a register.
6361
6362 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
6363 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
6364 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
6365 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform the
43aa4e05 6366 copy and the `movM' pattern should use memory as an intermediate storage.
36a05131
BS
6367 This case often occurs between floating-point and general registers. */
6368
6369enum reg_class
0a2aaacc 6370frv_secondary_reload_class (enum reg_class rclass,
f2206911 6371 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
35f2d8ef 6372 rtx x)
36a05131
BS
6373{
6374 enum reg_class ret;
6375
0a2aaacc 6376 switch (rclass)
36a05131
BS
6377 {
6378 default:
6379 ret = NO_REGS;
6380 break;
6381
6382 /* Accumulators/Accumulator guard registers need to go through floating
6383 point registers. */
6384 case QUAD_REGS:
36a05131
BS
6385 case GPR_REGS:
6386 ret = NO_REGS;
6387 if (x && GET_CODE (x) == REG)
6388 {
6389 int regno = REGNO (x);
6390
6391 if (ACC_P (regno) || ACCG_P (regno))
6392 ret = FPR_REGS;
6393 }
6394 break;
6395
9cd10576 6396 /* Nonzero constants should be loaded into an FPR through a GPR. */
36a05131 6397 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
36a05131
BS
6398 if (x && CONSTANT_P (x) && !ZERO_P (x))
6399 ret = GPR_REGS;
6400 else
6401 ret = NO_REGS;
6402 break;
6403
6404 /* All of these types need gpr registers. */
6405 case ICC_REGS:
6406 case FCC_REGS:
6407 case CC_REGS:
6408 case ICR_REGS:
6409 case FCR_REGS:
6410 case CR_REGS:
6411 case LCR_REG:
6412 case LR_REG:
6413 ret = GPR_REGS;
6414 break;
6415
35f2d8ef 6416 /* The accumulators need fpr registers. */
36a05131
BS
6417 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6418 case ACCG_REGS:
6419 ret = FPR_REGS;
6420 break;
6421 }
6422
6423 return ret;
6424}
6425
35f2d8ef
NC
6426/* This hook exists to catch the case where secondary_reload_class() is
6427 called from init_reg_autoinc() in regclass.c - before the reload optabs
6428 have been initialised. */
6429
a87cf97e
JR
6430static reg_class_t
6431frv_secondary_reload (bool in_p, rtx x, reg_class_t reload_class_i,
35f2d8ef
NC
6432 enum machine_mode reload_mode,
6433 secondary_reload_info * sri)
6434{
6435 enum reg_class rclass = NO_REGS;
a87cf97e 6436 enum reg_class reload_class = (enum reg_class) reload_class_i;
35f2d8ef
NC
6437
6438 if (sri->prev_sri && sri->prev_sri->t_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6439 {
6440 sri->icode = sri->prev_sri->t_icode;
6441 return NO_REGS;
6442 }
6443
6444 rclass = frv_secondary_reload_class (reload_class, reload_mode, x);
6445
6446 if (rclass != NO_REGS)
6447 {
f9621cc4
RS
6448 enum insn_code icode
6449 = direct_optab_handler (in_p ? reload_in_optab : reload_out_optab,
6450 reload_mode);
35f2d8ef
NC
6451 if (icode == 0)
6452 {
6453 /* This happens when then the reload_[in|out]_optabs have
6454 not been initialised. */
6455 sri->t_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6456 return rclass;
6457 }
6458 }
6459
6460 /* Fall back to the default secondary reload handler. */
6461 return default_secondary_reload (in_p, x, reload_class, reload_mode, sri);
6462
6463}
36a05131 6464\f
c28350ab 6465/* Worker function for TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P. */
36a05131 6466
c28350ab
AS
6467static bool
6468frv_class_likely_spilled_p (reg_class_t rclass)
36a05131 6469{
0a2aaacc 6470 switch (rclass)
36a05131
BS
6471 {
6472 default:
6473 break;
6474
17c21957
AO
6475 case GR8_REGS:
6476 case GR9_REGS:
6477 case GR89_REGS:
6478 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6479 case FDPIC_REGS:
36a05131
BS
6480 case ICC_REGS:
6481 case FCC_REGS:
6482 case CC_REGS:
6483 case ICR_REGS:
6484 case FCR_REGS:
6485 case CR_REGS:
6486 case LCR_REG:
6487 case LR_REG:
6488 case SPR_REGS:
6489 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
36a05131 6490 case ACCG_REGS:
c28350ab 6491 return true;
36a05131
BS
6492 }
6493
c28350ab 6494 return false;
36a05131
BS
6495}
6496
6497\f
6498/* An expression for the alignment of a structure field FIELD if the
7ec022b2 6499 alignment computed in the usual way is COMPUTED. GCC uses this
36a05131
BS
6500 value instead of the value in `BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT' or
6501 `BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT', if defined, for structure fields only. */
6502
6503/* The definition type of the bit field data is either char, short, long or
6504 long long. The maximum bit size is the number of bits of its own type.
6505
6506 The bit field data is assigned to a storage unit that has an adequate size
6507 for bit field data retention and is located at the smallest address.
6508
6509 Consecutive bit field data are packed at consecutive bits having the same
6510 storage unit, with regard to the type, beginning with the MSB and continuing
6511 toward the LSB.
6512
6513 If a field to be assigned lies over a bit field type boundary, its
6514 assignment is completed by aligning it with a boundary suitable for the
6515 type.
6516
6517 When a bit field having a bit length of 0 is declared, it is forcibly
6518 assigned to the next storage unit.
6519
6520 e.g)
6521 struct {
6522 int a:2;
6523 int b:6;
6524 char c:4;
6525 int d:10;
6526 int :0;
6527 int f:2;
6528 } x;
6529
6530 +0 +1 +2 +3
6531 &x 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6532 MLM----L
6533 a b
6534 &x+4 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6535 M--L
6536 c
6537 &x+8 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6538 M----------L
6539 d
6540 &x+12 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6541 ML
6542 f
6543*/
6544
6545int
f2206911 6546frv_adjust_field_align (tree field, int computed)
36a05131 6547{
b16c1435
EC
6548 /* Make sure that the bitfield is not wider than the type. */
6549 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
25f93e18 6550 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (field))
36a05131
BS
6551 {
6552 tree parent = DECL_CONTEXT (field);
6553 tree prev = NULL_TREE;
6554 tree cur;
6555
910ad8de 6556 for (cur = TYPE_FIELDS (parent); cur && cur != field; cur = DECL_CHAIN (cur))
36a05131
BS
6557 {
6558 if (TREE_CODE (cur) != FIELD_DECL)
6559 continue;
6560
6561 prev = cur;
6562 }
6563
44e91694 6564 gcc_assert (cur);
36a05131
BS
6565
6566 /* If this isn't a :0 field and if the previous element is a bitfield
6567 also, see if the type is different, if so, we will need to align the
87b483a1 6568 bit-field to the next boundary. */
36a05131
BS
6569 if (prev
6570 && ! DECL_PACKED (field)
6571 && ! integer_zerop (DECL_SIZE (field))
6572 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field) != DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (prev))
6573 {
6574 int prev_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (prev));
6575 int cur_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (field));
6576 computed = (prev_align > cur_align) ? prev_align : cur_align;
6577 }
6578 }
6579
6580 return computed;
6581}
6582
6583\f
6584/* A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value of mode
6585 MODE in hard register number REGNO (or in several registers starting with
6586 that one). For a machine where all registers are equivalent, a suitable
6587 definition is
6588
6589 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
6590
6591 It is not necessary for this macro to check for the numbers of fixed
6592 registers, because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always
6593 occupied.
6594
6595 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd register
6596 pairs. The way to implement that is to define this macro to reject odd
6597 register numbers for such modes.
6598
6599 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
6600 `movMODE' instruction pattern support moves between the register and any
6601 other hard register for which the mode is OK; and that moving a value into
6602 the register and back out not alter it.
6603
6604 Since the same instruction used to move `SImode' will work for all narrower
6605 integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK'
6606 to distinguish between these modes, provided you define patterns `movhi',
6607 etc., to take advantage of this. This is useful because of the interaction
6608 between `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK' and `MODES_TIEABLE_P'; it is very desirable for
6609 all integer modes to be tieable.
6610
6611 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic. Often
6612 people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only in floating
6613 point registers. This is not true. Any registers that can hold integers
6614 can safely *hold* a floating point machine mode, whether or not floating
6615 arithmetic can be done on it in those registers. Integer move instructions
6616 can be used to move the values.
6617
6618 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine modes
6619 may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating registers
6620 normalize any value stored in them, because storing a non-floating value
6621 there would garble it. In this case, `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK' should reject
6622 fixed-point machine modes in floating registers. But if the floating
6623 registers do not automatically normalize, if you can store any bit pattern
6624 in one and retrieve it unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may
6625 go in a floating register, so you can define this macro to say so.
6626
6627 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that they
6628 are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic instructions.
6629 However, this is of no concern to `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK'. You handle it by
6630 writing the proper constraints for those instructions.
6631
6632 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access, so
6633 that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a register
6634 if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the floating
6635 registers are not in class `GENERAL_REGS', they will not be used unless some
6636 pattern's constraint asks for one. */
6637
6638int
f2206911 6639frv_hard_regno_mode_ok (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
36a05131
BS
6640{
6641 int base;
6642 int mask;
6643
6644 switch (mode)
6645 {
6646 case CCmode:
6647 case CC_UNSmode:
036ff63f 6648 case CC_NZmode:
36a05131
BS
6649 return ICC_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6650
6651 case CC_CCRmode:
6652 return CR_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6653
6654 case CC_FPmode:
6655 return FCC_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6656
6657 default:
6658 break;
6659 }
6660
6661 /* Set BASE to the first register in REGNO's class. Set MASK to the
6662 bits that must be clear in (REGNO - BASE) for the register to be
6663 well-aligned. */
6664 if (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode) || FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (mode))
6665 {
6666 if (ACCG_P (regno))
6667 {
6668 /* ACCGs store one byte. Two-byte quantities must start in
6669 even-numbered registers, four-byte ones in registers whose
6670 numbers are divisible by four, and so on. */
6671 base = ACCG_FIRST;
6672 mask = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1;
6673 }
6674 else
6675 {
b16c1435
EC
6676 /* The other registers store one word. */
6677 if (GPR_P (regno) || regno == AP_FIRST)
36a05131
BS
6678 base = GPR_FIRST;
6679
6680 else if (FPR_P (regno))
6681 base = FPR_FIRST;
6682
6683 else if (ACC_P (regno))
6684 base = ACC_FIRST;
6685
b16c1435
EC
6686 else if (SPR_P (regno))
6687 return mode == SImode;
6688
87b483a1 6689 /* Fill in the table. */
36a05131
BS
6690 else
6691 return 0;
6692
6693 /* Anything smaller than an SI is OK in any word-sized register. */
6694 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < 4)
6695 return 1;
6696
6697 mask = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4) - 1;
6698 }
6699 return (((regno - base) & mask) == 0);
6700 }
6701
6702 return 0;
6703}
6704
6705\f
6706/* A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting at
6707 register number REGNO, required to hold a value of mode MODE.
6708
6709 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable definition
6710 of this macro is
6711
6712 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
6713 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
6714 / UNITS_PER_WORD)) */
6715
6716/* On the FRV, make the CC_FP mode take 3 words in the integer registers, so
6717 that we can build the appropriate instructions to properly reload the
6718 values. Also, make the byte-sized accumulator guards use one guard
6719 for each byte. */
6720
6721int
f2206911 6722frv_hard_regno_nregs (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
36a05131
BS
6723{
6724 if (ACCG_P (regno))
6725 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
6726 else
6727 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6728}
6729
6730\f
6731/* A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers of
0a2aaacc 6732 class RCLASS needed to hold a value of mode MODE.
36a05131
BS
6733
6734 This is closely related to the macro `HARD_REGNO_NREGS'. In fact, the value
0a2aaacc
KG
6735 of the macro `CLASS_MAX_NREGS (RCLASS, MODE)' should be the maximum value of
6736 `HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO, MODE)' for all REGNO values in the class RCLASS.
36a05131
BS
6737
6738 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values in
6739 the reload pass.
6740
6741 This declaration is required. */
6742
6743int
0a2aaacc 6744frv_class_max_nregs (enum reg_class rclass, enum machine_mode mode)
36a05131 6745{
0a2aaacc 6746 if (rclass == ACCG_REGS)
36a05131
BS
6747 /* An N-byte value requires N accumulator guards. */
6748 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
6749 else
6750 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6751}
6752
6753\f
6754/* A C expression that is nonzero if X is a legitimate constant for an
6755 immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that X satisfies
6756 `CONSTANT_P', so you need not check this. In fact, `1' is a suitable
6757 definition for this macro on machines where anything `CONSTANT_P' is valid. */
6758
1a627b35
RS
6759static bool
6760frv_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
36a05131 6761{
34208acf
AO
6762 /* frv_cannot_force_const_mem always returns true for FDPIC. This
6763 means that the move expanders will be expected to deal with most
6764 kinds of constant, regardless of what we return here.
6765
1a627b35 6766 However, among its other duties, frv_legitimate_constant_p decides whether
34208acf
AO
6767 a constant can be entered into reg_equiv_constant[]. If we return true,
6768 reload can create new instances of the constant whenever it likes.
6769
6770 The idea is therefore to accept as many constants as possible (to give
6771 reload more freedom) while rejecting constants that can only be created
6772 at certain times. In particular, anything with a symbolic component will
6773 require use of the pseudo FDPIC register, which is only available before
6774 reload. */
6775 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
6776 return LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (x);
6777
87b483a1 6778 /* All of the integer constants are ok. */
36a05131
BS
6779 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_DOUBLE)
6780 return TRUE;
6781
87b483a1 6782 /* double integer constants are ok. */
1a627b35 6783 if (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode || mode == DImode)
36a05131
BS
6784 return TRUE;
6785
87b483a1 6786 /* 0 is always ok. */
36a05131
BS
6787 if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
6788 return TRUE;
6789
6790 /* If floating point is just emulated, allow any constant, since it will be
87b483a1 6791 constructed in the GPRs. */
36a05131
BS
6792 if (!TARGET_HAS_FPRS)
6793 return TRUE;
6794
6795 if (mode == DFmode && !TARGET_DOUBLE)
6796 return TRUE;
6797
6798 /* Otherwise store the constant away and do a load. */
6799 return FALSE;
6800}
036ff63f
RS
6801
6802/* Implement SELECT_CC_MODE. Choose CC_FP for floating-point comparisons,
6803 CC_NZ for comparisons against zero in which a single Z or N flag test
6804 is enough, CC_UNS for other unsigned comparisons, and CC for other
6805 signed comparisons. */
6806
6807enum machine_mode
6808frv_select_cc_mode (enum rtx_code code, rtx x, rtx y)
6809{
6810 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_FLOAT)
6811 return CC_FPmode;
6812
6813 switch (code)
6814 {
6815 case EQ:
6816 case NE:
6817 case LT:
6818 case GE:
6819 return y == const0_rtx ? CC_NZmode : CCmode;
6820
6821 case GTU:
6822 case GEU:
6823 case LTU:
6824 case LEU:
6825 return y == const0_rtx ? CC_NZmode : CC_UNSmode;
6826
6827 default:
6828 return CCmode;
6829 }
6830}
36a05131 6831\f
33124e84
AS
6832
6833/* Worker function for TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST. */
36a05131
BS
6834
6835#define HIGH_COST 40
6836#define MEDIUM_COST 3
6837#define LOW_COST 1
6838
33124e84
AS
6839static int
6840frv_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6841 reg_class_t from, reg_class_t to)
36a05131
BS
6842{
6843 switch (from)
6844 {
6845 default:
6846 break;
6847
6848 case QUAD_REGS:
36a05131 6849 case GPR_REGS:
73d7e266
VM
6850 case GR8_REGS:
6851 case GR9_REGS:
6852 case GR89_REGS:
6853 case FDPIC_REGS:
6854 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6855 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6856
36a05131
BS
6857 switch (to)
6858 {
6859 default:
6860 break;
6861
9b5db25d 6862 case QUAD_REGS:
36a05131 6863 case GPR_REGS:
73d7e266
VM
6864 case GR8_REGS:
6865 case GR9_REGS:
6866 case GR89_REGS:
6867 case FDPIC_REGS:
6868 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6869 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6870
36a05131
BS
6871 return LOW_COST;
6872
36a05131
BS
6873 case FPR_REGS:
6874 return LOW_COST;
6875
6876 case LCR_REG:
6877 case LR_REG:
6878 case SPR_REGS:
6879 return LOW_COST;
6880 }
6881
9b5db25d 6882 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
36a05131
BS
6883 switch (to)
6884 {
6885 default:
6886 break;
6887
6888 case QUAD_REGS:
36a05131 6889 case GPR_REGS:
73d7e266
VM
6890 case GR8_REGS:
6891 case GR9_REGS:
6892 case GR89_REGS:
6893 case FDPIC_REGS:
6894 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6895 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6896
36a05131
BS
6897 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6898 case ACCG_REGS:
6899 return MEDIUM_COST;
6900
9b5db25d 6901 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
36a05131
BS
6902 return LOW_COST;
6903 }
6904
6905 case LCR_REG:
6906 case LR_REG:
6907 case SPR_REGS:
6908 switch (to)
6909 {
6910 default:
6911 break;
6912
6913 case QUAD_REGS:
36a05131 6914 case GPR_REGS:
73d7e266
VM
6915 case GR8_REGS:
6916 case GR9_REGS:
6917 case GR89_REGS:
6918 case FDPIC_REGS:
6919 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6920 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6921
36a05131
BS
6922 return MEDIUM_COST;
6923 }
6924
36a05131
BS
6925 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6926 case ACCG_REGS:
6927 switch (to)
6928 {
6929 default:
6930 break;
6931
9b5db25d 6932 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
36a05131
BS
6933 return MEDIUM_COST;
6934
6935 }
6936 }
6937
6938 return HIGH_COST;
6939}
33124e84
AS
6940
6941/* Worker function for TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST. */
6942
6943static int
6944frv_memory_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6945 reg_class_t rclass ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6946 bool in ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6947{
6948 return 4;
6949}
6950
36a05131
BS
6951\f
6952/* Implementation of TARGET_ASM_INTEGER. In the FRV case we need to
6953 use ".picptr" to generate safe relocations for PIC code. We also
6954 need a fixup entry for aligned (non-debugging) code. */
6955
6956static bool
f2206911 6957frv_assemble_integer (rtx value, unsigned int size, int aligned_p)
36a05131 6958{
34208acf 6959 if ((flag_pic || TARGET_FDPIC) && size == UNITS_PER_WORD)
36a05131
BS
6960 {
6961 if (GET_CODE (value) == CONST
6962 || GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF
6963 || GET_CODE (value) == LABEL_REF)
6964 {
34208acf
AO
6965 if (TARGET_FDPIC && GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF
6966 && SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (value))
6967 {
6968 fputs ("\t.picptr\tfuncdesc(", asm_out_file);
6969 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, value);
6970 fputs (")\n", asm_out_file);
6971 return true;
6972 }
6973 else if (TARGET_FDPIC && GET_CODE (value) == CONST
6974 && frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (value))
6975 return false;
6976 if (aligned_p && !TARGET_FDPIC)
36a05131
BS
6977 {
6978 static int label_num = 0;
6979 char buf[256];
6980 const char *p;
6981
6982 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, "LCP", label_num++);
14966b94 6983 p = (* targetm.strip_name_encoding) (buf);
36a05131
BS
6984
6985 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s:\n", p);
6986 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s\n", FIXUP_SECTION_ASM_OP);
6987 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.picptr\t%s\n", p);
6988 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.previous\n");
6989 }
6990 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", value);
6991 return true;
6992 }
6993 if (!aligned_p)
6994 {
6995 /* We've set the unaligned SI op to NULL, so we always have to
6996 handle the unaligned case here. */
6997 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.4byte\t", value);
6998 return true;
6999 }
7000 }
7001 return default_assemble_integer (value, size, aligned_p);
7002}
7003
7004/* Function to set up the backend function structure. */
7005
7006static struct machine_function *
f2206911 7007frv_init_machine_status (void)
36a05131 7008{
a9429e29 7009 return ggc_alloc_cleared_machine_function ();
36a05131 7010}
ffb344c1 7011\f
28a60850
RS
7012/* Implement TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE. */
7013
c557edf4 7014int
28a60850
RS
7015frv_issue_rate (void)
7016{
7017 if (!TARGET_PACK)
7018 return 1;
7019
7020 switch (frv_cpu_type)
7021 {
7022 default:
7023 case FRV_CPU_FR300:
7024 case FRV_CPU_SIMPLE:
7025 return 1;
7026
7027 case FRV_CPU_FR400:
c557edf4
RS
7028 case FRV_CPU_FR405:
7029 case FRV_CPU_FR450:
28a60850
RS
7030 return 2;
7031
7032 case FRV_CPU_GENERIC:
7033 case FRV_CPU_FR500:
7034 case FRV_CPU_TOMCAT:
7035 return 4;
c557edf4
RS
7036
7037 case FRV_CPU_FR550:
7038 return 8;
28a60850
RS
7039 }
7040}
36a05131 7041\f
c557edf4
RS
7042/* A for_each_rtx callback. If X refers to an accumulator, return
7043 ACC_GROUP_ODD if the bit 2 of the register number is set and
7044 ACC_GROUP_EVEN if it is clear. Return 0 (ACC_GROUP_NONE)
7045 otherwise. */
36a05131 7046
c557edf4
RS
7047static int
7048frv_acc_group_1 (rtx *x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131 7049{
c557edf4 7050 if (REG_P (*x))
36a05131 7051 {
c557edf4
RS
7052 if (ACC_P (REGNO (*x)))
7053 return (REGNO (*x) - ACC_FIRST) & 4 ? ACC_GROUP_ODD : ACC_GROUP_EVEN;
7054 if (ACCG_P (REGNO (*x)))
7055 return (REGNO (*x) - ACCG_FIRST) & 4 ? ACC_GROUP_ODD : ACC_GROUP_EVEN;
7056 }
7057 return 0;
7058}
36a05131 7059
c557edf4 7060/* Return the value of INSN's acc_group attribute. */
36a05131 7061
c557edf4
RS
7062int
7063frv_acc_group (rtx insn)
7064{
7065 /* This distinction only applies to the FR550 packing constraints. */
7066 if (frv_cpu_type != FRV_CPU_FR550)
7067 return ACC_GROUP_NONE;
7068 return for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_acc_group_1, 0);
7069}
36a05131 7070
c557edf4
RS
7071/* Return the index of the DFA unit in FRV_UNIT_NAMES[] that instruction
7072 INSN will try to claim first. Since this value depends only on the
7073 type attribute, we can cache the results in FRV_TYPE_TO_UNIT[]. */
36a05131 7074
c557edf4
RS
7075static unsigned int
7076frv_insn_unit (rtx insn)
7077{
7078 enum attr_type type;
36a05131 7079
c557edf4
RS
7080 type = get_attr_type (insn);
7081 if (frv_type_to_unit[type] == ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes))
7082 {
7083 /* We haven't seen this type of instruction before. */
7084 state_t state;
7085 unsigned int unit;
36a05131 7086
c557edf4
RS
7087 /* Issue the instruction on its own to see which unit it prefers. */
7088 state = alloca (state_size ());
7089 state_reset (state);
7090 state_transition (state, insn);
36a05131 7091
c557edf4
RS
7092 /* Find out which unit was taken. */
7093 for (unit = 0; unit < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes); unit++)
7094 if (cpu_unit_reservation_p (state, frv_unit_codes[unit]))
7095 break;
36a05131 7096
44e91694 7097 gcc_assert (unit != ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes));
36a05131 7098
c557edf4 7099 frv_type_to_unit[type] = unit;
36a05131 7100 }
c557edf4
RS
7101 return frv_type_to_unit[type];
7102}
36a05131 7103
c557edf4 7104/* Return true if INSN issues to a branch unit. */
36a05131 7105
c557edf4
RS
7106static bool
7107frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (rtx insn)
7108{
7109 return frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)] == GROUP_B;
7110}
7111\f
5c5e8419
JR
7112/* The instructions in the packet, partitioned into groups. */
7113struct frv_packet_group {
7114 /* How many instructions in the packet belong to this group. */
7115 unsigned int num_insns;
7116
7117 /* A list of the instructions that belong to this group, in the order
7118 they appear in the rtl stream. */
7119 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7120
7121 /* The contents of INSNS after they have been sorted into the correct
7122 assembly-language order. Element X issues to unit X. The list may
7123 contain extra nops. */
7124 rtx sorted[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7125
7126 /* The member of frv_nops[] to use in sorted[]. */
7127 rtx nop;
7128};
7129
c557edf4
RS
7130/* The current state of the packing pass, implemented by frv_pack_insns. */
7131static struct {
7132 /* The state of the pipeline DFA. */
7133 state_t dfa_state;
7134
7135 /* Which hardware registers are set within the current packet,
7136 and the conditions under which they are set. */
7137 regstate_t regstate[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
7138
7139 /* The memory locations that have been modified so far in this
7140 packet. MEM is the memref and COND is the regstate_t condition
7141 under which it is set. */
7142 struct {
7143 rtx mem;
7144 regstate_t cond;
7145 } mems[2];
7146
7147 /* The number of valid entries in MEMS. The value is larger than
7148 ARRAY_SIZE (mems) if there were too many mems to record. */
7149 unsigned int num_mems;
7150
7151 /* The maximum number of instructions that can be packed together. */
7152 unsigned int issue_rate;
7153
7154 /* The instructions in the packet, partitioned into groups. */
5c5e8419 7155 struct frv_packet_group groups[NUM_GROUPS];
c557edf4
RS
7156
7157 /* The instructions that make up the current packet. */
7158 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7159 unsigned int num_insns;
7160} frv_packet;
7161
7162/* Return the regstate_t flags for the given COND_EXEC condition.
7163 Abort if the condition isn't in the right form. */
36a05131 7164
c557edf4
RS
7165static int
7166frv_cond_flags (rtx cond)
7167{
44e91694
NS
7168 gcc_assert ((GET_CODE (cond) == EQ || GET_CODE (cond) == NE)
7169 && GET_CODE (XEXP (cond, 0)) == REG
7170 && CR_P (REGNO (XEXP (cond, 0)))
7171 && XEXP (cond, 1) == const0_rtx);
7172 return ((REGNO (XEXP (cond, 0)) - CR_FIRST)
7173 | (GET_CODE (cond) == NE
7174 ? REGSTATE_IF_TRUE
7175 : REGSTATE_IF_FALSE));
c557edf4 7176}
36a05131 7177
36a05131 7178
c557edf4
RS
7179/* Return true if something accessed under condition COND2 can
7180 conflict with something written under condition COND1. */
36a05131 7181
c557edf4
RS
7182static bool
7183frv_regstate_conflict_p (regstate_t cond1, regstate_t cond2)
7184{
7185 /* If either reference was unconditional, we have a conflict. */
7186 if ((cond1 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) == 0
7187 || (cond2 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) == 0)
7188 return true;
7189
7190 /* The references might conflict if they were controlled by
7191 different CRs. */
7192 if ((cond1 & REGSTATE_CC_MASK) != (cond2 & REGSTATE_CC_MASK))
7193 return true;
7194
7195 /* They definitely conflict if they are controlled by the
7196 same condition. */
7197 if ((cond1 & cond2 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) != 0)
7198 return true;
7199
7200 return false;
36a05131
BS
7201}
7202
c557edf4
RS
7203
7204/* A for_each_rtx callback. Return 1 if *X depends on an instruction in
7205 the current packet. DATA points to a regstate_t that describes the
7206 condition under which *X might be set or used. */
36a05131
BS
7207
7208static int
c557edf4 7209frv_registers_conflict_p_1 (rtx *x, void *data)
36a05131 7210{
c557edf4
RS
7211 unsigned int regno, i;
7212 regstate_t cond;
36a05131 7213
c557edf4 7214 cond = *(regstate_t *) data;
36a05131 7215
c557edf4
RS
7216 if (GET_CODE (*x) == REG)
7217 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, *x)
7218 if ((frv_packet.regstate[regno] & REGSTATE_MODIFIED) != 0)
7219 if (frv_regstate_conflict_p (frv_packet.regstate[regno], cond))
7220 return 1;
36a05131 7221
c557edf4
RS
7222 if (GET_CODE (*x) == MEM)
7223 {
7224 /* If we ran out of memory slots, assume a conflict. */
7225 if (frv_packet.num_mems > ARRAY_SIZE (frv_packet.mems))
7226 return 1;
36a05131 7227
c557edf4
RS
7228 /* Check for output or true dependencies with earlier MEMs. */
7229 for (i = 0; i < frv_packet.num_mems; i++)
7230 if (frv_regstate_conflict_p (frv_packet.mems[i].cond, cond))
7231 {
53d9622b 7232 if (true_dependence (frv_packet.mems[i].mem, VOIDmode, *x))
c557edf4 7233 return 1;
36a05131 7234
c557edf4
RS
7235 if (output_dependence (frv_packet.mems[i].mem, *x))
7236 return 1;
7237 }
7238 }
36a05131 7239
c557edf4
RS
7240 /* The return values of calls aren't significant: they describe
7241 the effect of the call as a whole, not of the insn itself. */
7242 if (GET_CODE (*x) == SET && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (*x)) == CALL)
7243 {
7244 if (for_each_rtx (&SET_SRC (*x), frv_registers_conflict_p_1, data))
7245 return 1;
7246 return -1;
7247 }
36a05131 7248
c557edf4
RS
7249 /* Check subexpressions. */
7250 return 0;
7251}
36a05131 7252
36a05131 7253
c557edf4
RS
7254/* Return true if something in X might depend on an instruction
7255 in the current packet. */
36a05131 7256
c557edf4
RS
7257static bool
7258frv_registers_conflict_p (rtx x)
7259{
7260 regstate_t flags;
36a05131 7261
c557edf4
RS
7262 flags = 0;
7263 if (GET_CODE (x) == COND_EXEC)
7264 {
7265 if (for_each_rtx (&XEXP (x, 0), frv_registers_conflict_p_1, &flags))
7266 return true;
36a05131 7267
c557edf4
RS
7268 flags |= frv_cond_flags (XEXP (x, 0));
7269 x = XEXP (x, 1);
36a05131 7270 }
c557edf4
RS
7271 return for_each_rtx (&x, frv_registers_conflict_p_1, &flags);
7272}
36a05131
BS
7273
7274
c557edf4
RS
7275/* A note_stores callback. DATA points to the regstate_t condition
7276 under which X is modified. Update FRV_PACKET accordingly. */
36a05131 7277
c557edf4 7278static void
7bc980e1 7279frv_registers_update_1 (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
c557edf4
RS
7280{
7281 unsigned int regno;
7282
7283 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
7284 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, x)
7285 frv_packet.regstate[regno] |= *(regstate_t *) data;
7286
7287 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
36a05131 7288 {
c557edf4 7289 if (frv_packet.num_mems < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_packet.mems))
36a05131 7290 {
c557edf4
RS
7291 frv_packet.mems[frv_packet.num_mems].mem = x;
7292 frv_packet.mems[frv_packet.num_mems].cond = *(regstate_t *) data;
7293 }
7294 frv_packet.num_mems++;
7295 }
7296}
36a05131 7297
36a05131 7298
c557edf4
RS
7299/* Update the register state information for an instruction whose
7300 body is X. */
7301
7302static void
7303frv_registers_update (rtx x)
7304{
7305 regstate_t flags;
7306
7307 flags = REGSTATE_MODIFIED;
7308 if (GET_CODE (x) == COND_EXEC)
7309 {
7310 flags |= frv_cond_flags (XEXP (x, 0));
7311 x = XEXP (x, 1);
36a05131 7312 }
c557edf4
RS
7313 note_stores (x, frv_registers_update_1, &flags);
7314}
36a05131 7315
c557edf4
RS
7316
7317/* Initialize frv_packet for the start of a new packet. */
7318
7319static void
7320frv_start_packet (void)
7321{
7322 enum frv_insn_group group;
7323
7324 memset (frv_packet.regstate, 0, sizeof (frv_packet.regstate));
7325 frv_packet.num_mems = 0;
7326 frv_packet.num_insns = 0;
5c5e8419
JR
7327 for (group = GROUP_I; group < NUM_GROUPS;
7328 group = (enum frv_insn_group) (group + 1))
c557edf4 7329 frv_packet.groups[group].num_insns = 0;
36a05131
BS
7330}
7331
36a05131 7332
c557edf4
RS
7333/* Likewise for the start of a new basic block. */
7334
7335static void
7336frv_start_packet_block (void)
36a05131 7337{
c557edf4
RS
7338 state_reset (frv_packet.dfa_state);
7339 frv_start_packet ();
7340}
36a05131 7341
c557edf4
RS
7342
7343/* Finish the current packet, if any, and start a new one. Call
7344 HANDLE_PACKET with FRV_PACKET describing the completed packet. */
7345
7346static void
7347frv_finish_packet (void (*handle_packet) (void))
7348{
7349 if (frv_packet.num_insns > 0)
36a05131 7350 {
c557edf4
RS
7351 handle_packet ();
7352 state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, 0);
7353 frv_start_packet ();
7354 }
7355}
36a05131 7356
36a05131 7357
c557edf4
RS
7358/* Return true if INSN can be added to the current packet. Update
7359 the DFA state on success. */
36a05131 7360
c557edf4
RS
7361static bool
7362frv_pack_insn_p (rtx insn)
7363{
7364 /* See if the packet is already as long as it can be. */
7365 if (frv_packet.num_insns == frv_packet.issue_rate)
7366 return false;
36a05131 7367
c557edf4
RS
7368 /* If the scheduler thought that an instruction should start a packet,
7369 it's usually a good idea to believe it. It knows much more about
7370 the latencies than we do.
36a05131 7371
c557edf4 7372 There are some exceptions though:
36a05131 7373
c557edf4
RS
7374 - Conditional instructions are scheduled on the assumption that
7375 they will be executed. This is usually a good thing, since it
c112cf2b 7376 tends to avoid unnecessary stalls in the conditional code.
c557edf4
RS
7377 But we want to pack conditional instructions as tightly as
7378 possible, in order to optimize the case where they aren't
7379 executed.
36a05131 7380
c557edf4
RS
7381 - The scheduler will always put branches on their own, even
7382 if there's no real dependency.
36a05131 7383
c557edf4
RS
7384 - There's no point putting a call in its own packet unless
7385 we have to. */
7386 if (frv_packet.num_insns > 0
7387 && GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
7388 && GET_MODE (insn) == TImode
7389 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != COND_EXEC)
7390 return false;
36a05131 7391
c557edf4
RS
7392 /* Check for register conflicts. Don't do this for setlo since any
7393 conflict will be with the partnering sethi, with which it can
7394 be packed. */
7395 if (get_attr_type (insn) != TYPE_SETLO)
7396 if (frv_registers_conflict_p (PATTERN (insn)))
7397 return false;
36a05131 7398
c557edf4
RS
7399 return state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, insn) < 0;
7400}
36a05131 7401
36a05131 7402
c557edf4 7403/* Add instruction INSN to the current packet. */
36a05131 7404
c557edf4
RS
7405static void
7406frv_add_insn_to_packet (rtx insn)
7407{
7408 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7409
7410 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)]];
7411 packet_group->insns[packet_group->num_insns++] = insn;
7412 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = insn;
7413
7414 frv_registers_update (PATTERN (insn));
36a05131
BS
7415}
7416
c557edf4
RS
7417
7418/* Insert INSN (a member of frv_nops[]) into the current packet. If the
7419 packet ends in a branch or call, insert the nop before it, otherwise
7420 add to the end. */
36a05131
BS
7421
7422static void
c557edf4 7423frv_insert_nop_in_packet (rtx insn)
36a05131 7424{
c557edf4
RS
7425 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7426 rtx last;
7427
7428 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)]];
7429 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
7430 if (GET_CODE (last) != INSN)
7431 {
7432 insn = emit_insn_before (PATTERN (insn), last);
7433 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1] = insn;
7434 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = last;
7435 }
7436 else
7437 {
7438 insn = emit_insn_after (PATTERN (insn), last);
7439 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = insn;
7440 }
7441 packet_group->insns[packet_group->num_insns++] = insn;
7442}
7443
36a05131 7444
c557edf4
RS
7445/* If packing is enabled, divide the instructions into packets and
7446 return true. Call HANDLE_PACKET for each complete packet. */
7447
7448static bool
7449frv_for_each_packet (void (*handle_packet) (void))
7450{
7451 rtx insn, next_insn;
7452
7453 frv_packet.issue_rate = frv_issue_rate ();
7454
7455 /* Early exit if we don't want to pack insns. */
28a60850
RS
7456 if (!optimize
7457 || !flag_schedule_insns_after_reload
0b2c18fe 7458 || !TARGET_VLIW_BRANCH
c557edf4
RS
7459 || frv_packet.issue_rate == 1)
7460 return false;
36a05131 7461
c557edf4 7462 /* Set up the initial packing state. */
36a05131 7463 dfa_start ();
c557edf4 7464 frv_packet.dfa_state = alloca (state_size ());
36a05131 7465
c557edf4
RS
7466 frv_start_packet_block ();
7467 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != 0; insn = next_insn)
36a05131 7468 {
c557edf4
RS
7469 enum rtx_code code;
7470 bool eh_insn_p;
36a05131 7471
c557edf4
RS
7472 code = GET_CODE (insn);
7473 next_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
7474
7475 if (code == CODE_LABEL)
36a05131 7476 {
c557edf4
RS
7477 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7478 frv_start_packet_block ();
7479 }
36a05131 7480
c557edf4
RS
7481 if (INSN_P (insn))
7482 switch (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)))
7483 {
7484 case USE:
7485 case CLOBBER:
7486 case ADDR_VEC:
7487 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
7488 break;
36a05131 7489
c557edf4
RS
7490 default:
7491 /* Calls mustn't be packed on a TOMCAT. */
7492 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN && frv_cpu_type == FRV_CPU_TOMCAT)
7493 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7494
7495 /* Since the last instruction in a packet determines the EH
7496 region, any exception-throwing instruction must come at
7497 the end of reordered packet. Insns that issue to a
7498 branch unit are bound to come last; for others it's
7499 too hard to predict. */
7500 eh_insn_p = (find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL) != NULL);
7501 if (eh_insn_p && !frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (insn))
7502 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7503
7504 /* Finish the current packet if we can't add INSN to it.
7505 Simulate cycles until INSN is ready to issue. */
7506 if (!frv_pack_insn_p (insn))
7507 {
7508 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7509 while (!frv_pack_insn_p (insn))
7510 state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, 0);
7511 }
36a05131 7512
c557edf4
RS
7513 /* Add the instruction to the packet. */
7514 frv_add_insn_to_packet (insn);
7515
7516 /* Calls and jumps end a packet, as do insns that throw
7517 an exception. */
7518 if (code == CALL_INSN || code == JUMP_INSN || eh_insn_p)
7519 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7520 break;
7521 }
7522 }
7523 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7524 dfa_finish ();
7525 return true;
7526}
7527\f
7528/* Subroutine of frv_sort_insn_group. We are trying to sort
7529 frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[0...NUM_INSNS-1] into assembly
7530 language order. We have already picked a new position for
7531 frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[X] if bit X of ISSUED is set.
7532 These instructions will occupy elements [0, LOWER_SLOT) and
7533 [UPPER_SLOT, NUM_INSNS) of the final (sorted) array. STATE is
7534 the DFA state after issuing these instructions.
7535
7536 Try filling elements [LOWER_SLOT, UPPER_SLOT) with every permutation
7537 of the unused instructions. Return true if one such permutation gives
7538 a valid ordering, leaving the successful permutation in sorted[].
7539 Do not modify sorted[] until a valid permutation is found. */
7540
7541static bool
7542frv_sort_insn_group_1 (enum frv_insn_group group,
7543 unsigned int lower_slot, unsigned int upper_slot,
7544 unsigned int issued, unsigned int num_insns,
7545 state_t state)
7546{
7547 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7548 unsigned int i;
7549 state_t test_state;
7550 size_t dfa_size;
7551 rtx insn;
7552
7553 /* Early success if we've filled all the slots. */
7554 if (lower_slot == upper_slot)
7555 return true;
7556
7557 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7558 dfa_size = state_size ();
7559 test_state = alloca (dfa_size);
7560
7561 /* Try issuing each unused instruction. */
7562 for (i = num_insns - 1; i + 1 != 0; i--)
7563 if (~issued & (1 << i))
7564 {
7565 insn = packet_group->sorted[i];
7566 memcpy (test_state, state, dfa_size);
7567 if (state_transition (test_state, insn) < 0
7568 && cpu_unit_reservation_p (test_state,
7569 NTH_UNIT (group, upper_slot - 1))
7570 && frv_sort_insn_group_1 (group, lower_slot, upper_slot - 1,
7571 issued | (1 << i), num_insns,
7572 test_state))
7573 {
7574 packet_group->sorted[upper_slot - 1] = insn;
7575 return true;
7576 }
7577 }
7578
7579 return false;
7580}
7581
7582/* Compare two instructions by their frv_insn_unit. */
7583
7584static int
7585frv_compare_insns (const void *first, const void *second)
7586{
5ead67f6
KG
7587 const rtx *const insn1 = (rtx const *) first,
7588 *const insn2 = (rtx const *) second;
c557edf4
RS
7589 return frv_insn_unit (*insn1) - frv_insn_unit (*insn2);
7590}
7591
7592/* Copy frv_packet.groups[GROUP].insns[] to frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[]
7593 and sort it into assembly language order. See frv.md for a description of
7594 the algorithm. */
7595
7596static void
7597frv_sort_insn_group (enum frv_insn_group group)
7598{
7599 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7600 unsigned int first, i, nop, max_unit, num_slots;
7601 state_t state, test_state;
7602 size_t dfa_size;
7603
7604 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
75d0ac8d
RS
7605
7606 /* Assume no nop is needed. */
7607 packet_group->nop = 0;
7608
c557edf4
RS
7609 if (packet_group->num_insns == 0)
7610 return;
7611
7612 /* Copy insns[] to sorted[]. */
7613 memcpy (packet_group->sorted, packet_group->insns,
7614 sizeof (rtx) * packet_group->num_insns);
7615
7616 /* Sort sorted[] by the unit that each insn tries to take first. */
7617 if (packet_group->num_insns > 1)
7618 qsort (packet_group->sorted, packet_group->num_insns,
7619 sizeof (rtx), frv_compare_insns);
7620
7621 /* That's always enough for branch and control insns. */
7622 if (group == GROUP_B || group == GROUP_C)
7623 return;
7624
7625 dfa_size = state_size ();
7626 state = alloca (dfa_size);
7627 test_state = alloca (dfa_size);
7628
7629 /* Find the highest FIRST such that sorted[0...FIRST-1] can issue
7630 consecutively and such that the DFA takes unit X when sorted[X]
7631 is added. Set STATE to the new DFA state. */
7632 state_reset (test_state);
7633 for (first = 0; first < packet_group->num_insns; first++)
7634 {
7635 memcpy (state, test_state, dfa_size);
7636 if (state_transition (test_state, packet_group->sorted[first]) >= 0
7637 || !cpu_unit_reservation_p (test_state, NTH_UNIT (group, first)))
7638 break;
7639 }
7640
7641 /* If all the instructions issued in ascending order, we're done. */
7642 if (first == packet_group->num_insns)
7643 return;
36a05131 7644
c557edf4
RS
7645 /* Add nops to the end of sorted[] and try each permutation until
7646 we find one that works. */
7647 for (nop = 0; nop < frv_num_nops; nop++)
7648 {
7649 max_unit = frv_insn_unit (frv_nops[nop]);
7650 if (frv_unit_groups[max_unit] == group)
36a05131 7651 {
c557edf4
RS
7652 packet_group->nop = frv_nops[nop];
7653 num_slots = UNIT_NUMBER (max_unit) + 1;
7654 for (i = packet_group->num_insns; i < num_slots; i++)
7655 packet_group->sorted[i] = frv_nops[nop];
7656 if (frv_sort_insn_group_1 (group, first, num_slots,
7657 (1 << first) - 1, num_slots, state))
7658 return;
36a05131 7659 }
c557edf4 7660 }
44e91694 7661 gcc_unreachable ();
c557edf4
RS
7662}
7663\f
7664/* Sort the current packet into assembly-language order. Set packing
7665 flags as appropriate. */
36a05131 7666
c557edf4
RS
7667static void
7668frv_reorder_packet (void)
7669{
7670 unsigned int cursor[NUM_GROUPS];
7671 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_groups)];
7672 unsigned int unit, to, from;
7673 enum frv_insn_group group;
7674 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7675
7676 /* First sort each group individually. */
5c5e8419
JR
7677 for (group = GROUP_I; group < NUM_GROUPS;
7678 group = (enum frv_insn_group) (group + 1))
c557edf4
RS
7679 {
7680 cursor[group] = 0;
7681 frv_sort_insn_group (group);
7682 }
7683
7684 /* Go through the unit template and try add an instruction from
7685 that unit's group. */
7686 to = 0;
7687 for (unit = 0; unit < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_groups); unit++)
7688 {
7689 group = frv_unit_groups[unit];
7690 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7691 if (cursor[group] < packet_group->num_insns)
36a05131 7692 {
c557edf4 7693 /* frv_reorg should have added nops for us. */
44e91694
NS
7694 gcc_assert (packet_group->sorted[cursor[group]]
7695 != packet_group->nop);
c557edf4 7696 insns[to++] = packet_group->sorted[cursor[group]++];
36a05131 7697 }
c557edf4 7698 }
36a05131 7699
44e91694 7700 gcc_assert (to == frv_packet.num_insns);
36a05131 7701
c557edf4
RS
7702 /* Clear the last instruction's packing flag, thus marking the end of
7703 a packet. Reorder the other instructions relative to it. */
7704 CLEAR_PACKING_FLAG (insns[to - 1]);
7705 for (from = 0; from < to - 1; from++)
7706 {
7707 remove_insn (insns[from]);
6fb5fa3c 7708 add_insn_before (insns[from], insns[to - 1], NULL);
c557edf4
RS
7709 SET_PACKING_FLAG (insns[from]);
7710 }
7711}
36a05131 7712
36a05131 7713
c557edf4
RS
7714/* Divide instructions into packets. Reorder the contents of each
7715 packet so that they are in the correct assembly-language order.
7716
7717 Since this pass can change the raw meaning of the rtl stream, it must
7718 only be called at the last minute, just before the instructions are
7719 written out. */
7720
7721static void
7722frv_pack_insns (void)
7723{
7724 if (frv_for_each_packet (frv_reorder_packet))
7725 frv_insn_packing_flag = 0;
7726 else
7727 frv_insn_packing_flag = -1;
7728}
7729\f
7730/* See whether we need to add nops to group GROUP in order to
7731 make a valid packet. */
7732
7733static void
7734frv_fill_unused_units (enum frv_insn_group group)
7735{
7736 unsigned int non_nops, nops, i;
7737 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7738
7739 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7740
7741 /* Sort the instructions into assembly-language order.
7742 Use nops to fill slots that are otherwise unused. */
7743 frv_sort_insn_group (group);
7744
7745 /* See how many nops are needed before the final useful instruction. */
7746 i = nops = 0;
7747 for (non_nops = 0; non_nops < packet_group->num_insns; non_nops++)
7748 while (packet_group->sorted[i++] == packet_group->nop)
7749 nops++;
7750
7751 /* Insert that many nops into the instruction stream. */
7752 while (nops-- > 0)
7753 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (packet_group->nop);
7754}
7755
38c28a25
AH
7756/* Return true if accesses IO1 and IO2 refer to the same doubleword. */
7757
7758static bool
7759frv_same_doubleword_p (const struct frv_io *io1, const struct frv_io *io2)
7760{
7761 if (io1->const_address != 0 && io2->const_address != 0)
7762 return io1->const_address == io2->const_address;
7763
7764 if (io1->var_address != 0 && io2->var_address != 0)
7765 return rtx_equal_p (io1->var_address, io2->var_address);
7766
7767 return false;
7768}
7769
7770/* Return true if operations IO1 and IO2 are guaranteed to complete
7771 in order. */
7772
7773static bool
7774frv_io_fixed_order_p (const struct frv_io *io1, const struct frv_io *io2)
7775{
7776 /* The order of writes is always preserved. */
7777 if (io1->type == FRV_IO_WRITE && io2->type == FRV_IO_WRITE)
7778 return true;
7779
7780 /* The order of reads isn't preserved. */
7781 if (io1->type != FRV_IO_WRITE && io2->type != FRV_IO_WRITE)
7782 return false;
7783
7784 /* One operation is a write and the other is (or could be) a read.
7785 The order is only guaranteed if the accesses are to the same
7786 doubleword. */
7787 return frv_same_doubleword_p (io1, io2);
7788}
7789
7790/* Generalize I/O operation X so that it covers both X and Y. */
7791
7792static void
7793frv_io_union (struct frv_io *x, const struct frv_io *y)
7794{
7795 if (x->type != y->type)
7796 x->type = FRV_IO_UNKNOWN;
7797 if (!frv_same_doubleword_p (x, y))
7798 {
7799 x->const_address = 0;
7800 x->var_address = 0;
7801 }
7802}
7803
7804/* Fill IO with information about the load or store associated with
7805 membar instruction INSN. */
7806
7807static void
7808frv_extract_membar (struct frv_io *io, rtx insn)
7809{
7810 extract_insn (insn);
5c5e8419 7811 io->type = (enum frv_io_type) INTVAL (recog_data.operand[2]);
38c28a25
AH
7812 io->const_address = INTVAL (recog_data.operand[1]);
7813 io->var_address = XEXP (recog_data.operand[0], 0);
7814}
7815
7816/* A note_stores callback for which DATA points to an rtx. Nullify *DATA
7817 if X is a register and *DATA depends on X. */
7818
7819static void
7bc980e1 7820frv_io_check_address (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
38c28a25 7821{
5ead67f6 7822 rtx *other = (rtx *) data;
38c28a25
AH
7823
7824 if (REG_P (x) && *other != 0 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, *other))
7825 *other = 0;
7826}
7827
7828/* A note_stores callback for which DATA points to a HARD_REG_SET.
7829 Remove every modified register from the set. */
7830
7831static void
7bc980e1 7832frv_io_handle_set (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
38c28a25 7833{
5ead67f6 7834 HARD_REG_SET *set = (HARD_REG_SET *) data;
38c28a25
AH
7835 unsigned int regno;
7836
7837 if (REG_P (x))
7838 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, x)
7839 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*set, regno);
7840}
7841
7842/* A for_each_rtx callback for which DATA points to a HARD_REG_SET.
7843 Add every register in *X to the set. */
7844
7845static int
7846frv_io_handle_use_1 (rtx *x, void *data)
7847{
5ead67f6 7848 HARD_REG_SET *set = (HARD_REG_SET *) data;
38c28a25
AH
7849 unsigned int regno;
7850
7851 if (REG_P (*x))
7852 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, *x)
7853 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*set, regno);
7854
7855 return 0;
7856}
7857
7858/* A note_stores callback that applies frv_io_handle_use_1 to an
7859 entire rhs value. */
7860
7861static void
7862frv_io_handle_use (rtx *x, void *data)
7863{
7864 for_each_rtx (x, frv_io_handle_use_1, data);
7865}
7866
7867/* Go through block BB looking for membars to remove. There are two
7868 cases where intra-block analysis is enough:
7869
7870 - a membar is redundant if it occurs between two consecutive I/O
7871 operations and if those operations are guaranteed to complete
7872 in order.
7873
7874 - a membar for a __builtin_read is redundant if the result is
7875 used before the next I/O operation is issued.
7876
7877 If the last membar in the block could not be removed, and there
7878 are guaranteed to be no I/O operations between that membar and
7879 the end of the block, store the membar in *LAST_MEMBAR, otherwise
7880 store null.
7881
7882 Describe the block's first I/O operation in *NEXT_IO. Describe
7883 an unknown operation if the block doesn't do any I/O. */
7884
7885static void
7886frv_optimize_membar_local (basic_block bb, struct frv_io *next_io,
7887 rtx *last_membar)
7888{
7889 HARD_REG_SET used_regs;
7890 rtx next_membar, set, insn;
7891 bool next_is_end_p;
7892
7893 /* NEXT_IO is the next I/O operation to be performed after the current
7894 instruction. It starts off as being an unknown operation. */
7895 memset (next_io, 0, sizeof (*next_io));
7896
7897 /* NEXT_IS_END_P is true if NEXT_IO describes the end of the block. */
7898 next_is_end_p = true;
7899
7900 /* If the current instruction is a __builtin_read or __builtin_write,
7901 NEXT_MEMBAR is the membar instruction associated with it. NEXT_MEMBAR
7902 is null if the membar has already been deleted.
7903
7904 Note that the initialization here should only be needed to
536fa7b7 7905 suppress warnings. */
38c28a25
AH
7906 next_membar = 0;
7907
7908 /* USED_REGS is the set of registers that are used before the
7909 next I/O instruction. */
7910 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
7911
7912 for (insn = BB_END (bb); insn != BB_HEAD (bb); insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
7913 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
7914 {
7915 /* We can't predict what a call will do to volatile memory. */
7916 memset (next_io, 0, sizeof (struct frv_io));
7917 next_is_end_p = false;
7918 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
7919 }
7920 else if (INSN_P (insn))
7921 switch (recog_memoized (insn))
7922 {
7923 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi:
7924 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi:
7925 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si:
7926 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di:
7927 next_membar = insn;
7928 if (next_is_end_p)
7929 {
7930 /* Local information isn't enough to decide whether this
7931 membar is needed. Stash it away for later. */
7932 *last_membar = insn;
7933 frv_extract_membar (next_io, insn);
7934 next_is_end_p = false;
7935 }
7936 else
7937 {
7938 /* Check whether the I/O operation before INSN could be
7939 reordered with one described by NEXT_IO. If it can't,
7940 INSN will not be needed. */
7941 struct frv_io prev_io;
7942
7943 frv_extract_membar (&prev_io, insn);
7944 if (frv_io_fixed_order_p (&prev_io, next_io))
7945 {
7946 if (dump_file)
7947 fprintf (dump_file,
7948 ";; [Local] Removing membar %d since order"
7949 " of accesses is guaranteed\n",
7950 INSN_UID (next_membar));
7951
7952 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
7953 delete_insn (next_membar);
7954 next_membar = 0;
7955 }
7956 *next_io = prev_io;
7957 }
7958 break;
7959
7960 default:
7961 /* Invalidate NEXT_IO's address if it depends on something that
7962 is clobbered by INSN. */
7963 if (next_io->var_address)
7964 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), frv_io_check_address,
7965 &next_io->var_address);
7966
7967 /* If the next membar is associated with a __builtin_read,
7968 see if INSN reads from that address. If it does, and if
7969 the destination register is used before the next I/O access,
7970 there is no need for the membar. */
7971 set = PATTERN (insn);
7972 if (next_io->type == FRV_IO_READ
7973 && next_io->var_address != 0
7974 && next_membar != 0
7975 && GET_CODE (set) == SET
7976 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
7977 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_regs, REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))
7978 {
7979 rtx src;
7980
7981 src = SET_SRC (set);
7982 if (GET_CODE (src) == ZERO_EXTEND)
7983 src = XEXP (src, 0);
7984
7985 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM
7986 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (src, 0), next_io->var_address))
7987 {
7988 if (dump_file)
7989 fprintf (dump_file,
7990 ";; [Local] Removing membar %d since the target"
7991 " of %d is used before the I/O operation\n",
7992 INSN_UID (next_membar), INSN_UID (insn));
7993
7994 if (next_membar == *last_membar)
7995 *last_membar = 0;
7996
7997 delete_insn (next_membar);
7998 next_membar = 0;
7999 }
8000 }
8001
8002 /* If INSN has volatile references, forget about any registers
8003 that are used after it. Otherwise forget about uses that
8004 are (or might be) defined by INSN. */
8005 if (volatile_refs_p (PATTERN (insn)))
8006 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
8007 else
8008 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), frv_io_handle_set, &used_regs);
8009
8010 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), frv_io_handle_use, &used_regs);
8011 break;
8012 }
8013}
8014
8015/* See if MEMBAR, the last membar instruction in BB, can be removed.
8016 FIRST_IO[X] describes the first operation performed by basic block X. */
8017
8018static void
8019frv_optimize_membar_global (basic_block bb, struct frv_io *first_io,
8020 rtx membar)
8021{
8022 struct frv_io this_io, next_io;
8023 edge succ;
8024 edge_iterator ei;
8025
8026 /* We need to keep the membar if there is an edge to the exit block. */
8027 FOR_EACH_EDGE (succ, ei, bb->succs)
8028 /* for (succ = bb->succ; succ != 0; succ = succ->succ_next) */
8029 if (succ->dest == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR)
8030 return;
8031
8032 /* Work out the union of all successor blocks. */
8033 ei = ei_start (bb->succs);
8034 ei_cond (ei, &succ);
8035 /* next_io = first_io[bb->succ->dest->index]; */
8036 next_io = first_io[succ->dest->index];
8037 ei = ei_start (bb->succs);
8038 if (ei_cond (ei, &succ))
8039 {
8040 for (ei_next (&ei); ei_cond (ei, &succ); ei_next (&ei))
8041 /*for (succ = bb->succ->succ_next; succ != 0; succ = succ->succ_next)*/
8042 frv_io_union (&next_io, &first_io[succ->dest->index]);
8043 }
8044 else
8045 gcc_unreachable ();
8046
8047 frv_extract_membar (&this_io, membar);
8048 if (frv_io_fixed_order_p (&this_io, &next_io))
8049 {
8050 if (dump_file)
8051 fprintf (dump_file,
8052 ";; [Global] Removing membar %d since order of accesses"
8053 " is guaranteed\n", INSN_UID (membar));
8054
8055 delete_insn (membar);
8056 }
8057}
8058
8059/* Remove redundant membars from the current function. */
8060
8061static void
8062frv_optimize_membar (void)
8063{
8064 basic_block bb;
8065 struct frv_io *first_io;
8066 rtx *last_membar;
8067
8068 compute_bb_for_insn ();
5ead67f6
KG
8069 first_io = XCNEWVEC (struct frv_io, last_basic_block);
8070 last_membar = XCNEWVEC (rtx, last_basic_block);
38c28a25
AH
8071
8072 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
8073 frv_optimize_membar_local (bb, &first_io[bb->index],
8074 &last_membar[bb->index]);
8075
8076 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
8077 if (last_membar[bb->index] != 0)
8078 frv_optimize_membar_global (bb, first_io, last_membar[bb->index]);
8079
8080 free (first_io);
8081 free (last_membar);
8082}
8083\f
c557edf4
RS
8084/* Used by frv_reorg to keep track of the current packet's address. */
8085static unsigned int frv_packet_address;
36a05131 8086
c557edf4
RS
8087/* If the current packet falls through to a label, try to pad the packet
8088 with nops in order to fit the label's alignment requirements. */
8089
8090static void
8091frv_align_label (void)
8092{
8093 unsigned int alignment, target, nop;
8094 rtx x, last, barrier, label;
8095
8096 /* Walk forward to the start of the next packet. Set ALIGNMENT to the
8097 maximum alignment of that packet, LABEL to the last label between
8098 the packets, and BARRIER to the last barrier. */
8099 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
8100 label = barrier = 0;
8101 alignment = 4;
8102 for (x = NEXT_INSN (last); x != 0 && !INSN_P (x); x = NEXT_INSN (x))
8103 {
8104 if (LABEL_P (x))
36a05131 8105 {
c557edf4
RS
8106 unsigned int subalign = 1 << label_to_alignment (x);
8107 alignment = MAX (alignment, subalign);
8108 label = x;
36a05131 8109 }
c557edf4
RS
8110 if (BARRIER_P (x))
8111 barrier = x;
8112 }
36a05131 8113
c557edf4
RS
8114 /* If -malign-labels, and the packet falls through to an unaligned
8115 label, try introducing a nop to align that label to 8 bytes. */
8116 if (TARGET_ALIGN_LABELS
8117 && label != 0
8118 && barrier == 0
8119 && frv_packet.num_insns < frv_packet.issue_rate)
8120 alignment = MAX (alignment, 8);
36a05131 8121
c557edf4
RS
8122 /* Advance the address to the end of the current packet. */
8123 frv_packet_address += frv_packet.num_insns * 4;
36a05131 8124
c557edf4
RS
8125 /* Work out the target address, after alignment. */
8126 target = (frv_packet_address + alignment - 1) & -alignment;
8127
8128 /* If the packet falls through to the label, try to find an efficient
8129 padding sequence. */
8130 if (barrier == 0)
8131 {
8132 /* First try adding nops to the current packet. */
8133 for (nop = 0; nop < frv_num_nops; nop++)
8134 while (frv_packet_address < target && frv_pack_insn_p (frv_nops[nop]))
8135 {
8136 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (frv_nops[nop]);
8137 frv_packet_address += 4;
8138 }
8139
8140 /* If we still haven't reached the target, add some new packets that
8141 contain only nops. If there are two types of nop, insert an
8142 alternating sequence of frv_nops[0] and frv_nops[1], which will
8143 lead to packets like:
8144
8145 nop.p
8146 mnop.p/fnop.p
8147 nop.p
8148 mnop/fnop
8149
8150 etc. Just emit frv_nops[0] if that's the only nop we have. */
8151 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
8152 nop = 0;
8153 while (frv_packet_address < target)
8154 {
8155 last = emit_insn_after (PATTERN (frv_nops[nop]), last);
8156 frv_packet_address += 4;
8157 if (frv_num_nops > 1)
8158 nop ^= 1;
36a05131
BS
8159 }
8160 }
8161
c557edf4 8162 frv_packet_address = target;
36a05131
BS
8163}
8164
c557edf4
RS
8165/* Subroutine of frv_reorg, called after each packet has been constructed
8166 in frv_packet. */
8167
8168static void
8169frv_reorg_packet (void)
8170{
8171 frv_fill_unused_units (GROUP_I);
8172 frv_fill_unused_units (GROUP_FM);
8173 frv_align_label ();
8174}
8175
8176/* Add an instruction with pattern NOP to frv_nops[]. */
8177
8178static void
8179frv_register_nop (rtx nop)
8180{
8181 nop = make_insn_raw (nop);
8182 NEXT_INSN (nop) = 0;
8183 PREV_INSN (nop) = 0;
8184 frv_nops[frv_num_nops++] = nop;
8185}
8186
8187/* Implement TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG. Divide the instructions
8188 into packets and check whether we need to insert nops in order to
8189 fulfill the processor's issue requirements. Also, if the user has
8190 requested a certain alignment for a label, try to meet that alignment
8191 by inserting nops in the previous packet. */
8192
8193static void
8194frv_reorg (void)
8195{
38c28a25
AH
8196 if (optimize > 0 && TARGET_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR && cfun->machine->has_membar_p)
8197 frv_optimize_membar ();
8198
c557edf4
RS
8199 frv_num_nops = 0;
8200 frv_register_nop (gen_nop ());
8201 if (TARGET_MEDIA)
8202 frv_register_nop (gen_mnop ());
8203 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
8204 frv_register_nop (gen_fnop ());
8205
8206 /* Estimate the length of each branch. Although this may change after
8207 we've inserted nops, it will only do so in big functions. */
8208 shorten_branches (get_insns ());
8209
8210 frv_packet_address = 0;
8211 frv_for_each_packet (frv_reorg_packet);
8212}
36a05131
BS
8213\f
8214#define def_builtin(name, type, code) \
c79efc4d 8215 add_builtin_function ((name), (type), (code), BUILT_IN_MD, NULL, NULL)
36a05131
BS
8216
8217struct builtin_description
8218{
8219 enum insn_code icode;
8220 const char *name;
8221 enum frv_builtins code;
8222 enum rtx_code comparison;
8223 unsigned int flag;
8224};
8225
8226/* Media intrinsics that take a single, constant argument. */
8227
8228static struct builtin_description bdesc_set[] =
8229{
5c5e8419 8230 { CODE_FOR_mhdsets, "__MHDSETS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS, UNKNOWN, 0 }
36a05131
BS
8231};
8232
87b483a1 8233/* Media intrinsics that take just one argument. */
36a05131
BS
8234
8235static struct builtin_description bdesc_1arg[] =
8236{
5c5e8419
JR
8237 { CODE_FOR_mnot, "__MNOT", FRV_BUILTIN_MNOT, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8238 { CODE_FOR_munpackh, "__MUNPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MUNPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8239 { CODE_FOR_mbtoh, "__MBTOH", FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOH, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8240 { CODE_FOR_mhtob, "__MHTOB", FRV_BUILTIN_MHTOB, UNKNOWN, 0},
8241 { CODE_FOR_mabshs, "__MABSHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8242 { CODE_FOR_scutss, "__SCUTSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS, UNKNOWN, 0 }
36a05131
BS
8243};
8244
87b483a1 8245/* Media intrinsics that take two arguments. */
36a05131
BS
8246
8247static struct builtin_description bdesc_2arg[] =
8248{
5c5e8419
JR
8249 { CODE_FOR_mand, "__MAND", FRV_BUILTIN_MAND, UNKNOWN, 0},
8250 { CODE_FOR_mor, "__MOR", FRV_BUILTIN_MOR, UNKNOWN, 0},
8251 { CODE_FOR_mxor, "__MXOR", FRV_BUILTIN_MXOR, UNKNOWN, 0},
8252 { CODE_FOR_maveh, "__MAVEH", FRV_BUILTIN_MAVEH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8253 { CODE_FOR_msaths, "__MSATHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8254 { CODE_FOR_msathu, "__MSATHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8255 { CODE_FOR_maddhss, "__MADDHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8256 { CODE_FOR_maddhus, "__MADDHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8257 { CODE_FOR_msubhss, "__MSUBHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8258 { CODE_FOR_msubhus, "__MSUBHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8259 { CODE_FOR_mqaddhss, "__MQADDHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8260 { CODE_FOR_mqaddhus, "__MQADDHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8261 { CODE_FOR_mqsubhss, "__MQSUBHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8262 { CODE_FOR_mqsubhus, "__MQSUBHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8263 { CODE_FOR_mpackh, "__MPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8264 { CODE_FOR_mcop1, "__Mcop1", FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1, UNKNOWN, 0},
8265 { CODE_FOR_mcop2, "__Mcop2", FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2, UNKNOWN, 0},
8266 { CODE_FOR_mwcut, "__MWCUT", FRV_BUILTIN_MWCUT, UNKNOWN, 0},
8267 { CODE_FOR_mqsaths, "__MQSATHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8268 { CODE_FOR_mqlclrhs, "__MQLCLRHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8269 { CODE_FOR_mqlmths, "__MQLMTHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8270 { CODE_FOR_smul, "__SMUL", FRV_BUILTIN_SMUL, UNKNOWN, 0},
8271 { CODE_FOR_umul, "__UMUL", FRV_BUILTIN_UMUL, UNKNOWN, 0},
8272 { CODE_FOR_addss, "__ADDSS", FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8273 { CODE_FOR_subss, "__SUBSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8274 { CODE_FOR_slass, "__SLASS", FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8275 { CODE_FOR_scan, "__SCAN", FRV_BUILTIN_SCAN, UNKNOWN, 0}
c557edf4
RS
8276};
8277
8278/* Integer intrinsics that take two arguments and have no return value. */
8279
8280static struct builtin_description bdesc_int_void2arg[] =
8281{
5c5e8419
JR
8282 { CODE_FOR_smass, "__SMASS", FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8283 { CODE_FOR_smsss, "__SMSSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8284 { CODE_FOR_smu, "__SMU", FRV_BUILTIN_SMU, UNKNOWN, 0}
c557edf4
RS
8285};
8286
8287static struct builtin_description bdesc_prefetches[] =
8288{
5c5e8419
JR
8289 { CODE_FOR_frv_prefetch0, "__data_prefetch0", FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH0, UNKNOWN,
8290 0},
8291 { CODE_FOR_frv_prefetch, "__data_prefetch", FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH, UNKNOWN, 0}
36a05131
BS
8292};
8293
8294/* Media intrinsics that take two arguments, the first being an ACC number. */
8295
8296static struct builtin_description bdesc_cut[] =
8297{
5c5e8419
JR
8298 { CODE_FOR_mcut, "__MCUT", FRV_BUILTIN_MCUT, UNKNOWN, 0},
8299 { CODE_FOR_mcutss, "__MCUTSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCUTSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8300 { CODE_FOR_mdcutssi, "__MDCUTSSI", FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI, UNKNOWN, 0}
36a05131
BS
8301};
8302
87b483a1 8303/* Two-argument media intrinsics with an immediate second argument. */
36a05131
BS
8304
8305static struct builtin_description bdesc_2argimm[] =
8306{
5c5e8419
JR
8307 { CODE_FOR_mrotli, "__MROTLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MROTLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8308 { CODE_FOR_mrotri, "__MROTRI", FRV_BUILTIN_MROTRI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8309 { CODE_FOR_msllhi, "__MSLLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSLLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8310 { CODE_FOR_msrlhi, "__MSRLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSRLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8311 { CODE_FOR_msrahi, "__MSRAHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSRAHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8312 { CODE_FOR_mexpdhw, "__MEXPDHW", FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHW, UNKNOWN, 0},
8313 { CODE_FOR_mexpdhd, "__MEXPDHD", FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHD, UNKNOWN, 0},
8314 { CODE_FOR_mdrotli, "__MDROTLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8315 { CODE_FOR_mcplhi, "__MCPLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8316 { CODE_FOR_mcpli, "__MCPLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8317 { CODE_FOR_mhsetlos, "__MHSETLOS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8318 { CODE_FOR_mhsetloh, "__MHSETLOH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8319 { CODE_FOR_mhsethis, "__MHSETHIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8320 { CODE_FOR_mhsethih, "__MHSETHIH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8321 { CODE_FOR_mhdseth, "__MHDSETH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8322 { CODE_FOR_mqsllhi, "__MQSLLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8323 { CODE_FOR_mqsrahi, "__MQSRAHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI, UNKNOWN, 0}
36a05131
BS
8324};
8325
8326/* Media intrinsics that take two arguments and return void, the first argument
87b483a1 8327 being a pointer to 4 words in memory. */
36a05131
BS
8328
8329static struct builtin_description bdesc_void2arg[] =
8330{
5c5e8419
JR
8331 { CODE_FOR_mdunpackh, "__MDUNPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8332 { CODE_FOR_mbtohe, "__MBTOHE", FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE, UNKNOWN, 0},
36a05131
BS
8333};
8334
8335/* Media intrinsics that take three arguments, the first being a const_int that
87b483a1 8336 denotes an accumulator, and that return void. */
36a05131
BS
8337
8338static struct builtin_description bdesc_void3arg[] =
8339{
5c5e8419
JR
8340 { CODE_FOR_mcpxrs, "__MCPXRS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8341 { CODE_FOR_mcpxru, "__MCPXRU", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8342 { CODE_FOR_mcpxis, "__MCPXIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8343 { CODE_FOR_mcpxiu, "__MCPXIU", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8344 { CODE_FOR_mmulhs, "__MMULHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8345 { CODE_FOR_mmulhu, "__MMULHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8346 { CODE_FOR_mmulxhs, "__MMULXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8347 { CODE_FOR_mmulxhu, "__MMULXHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8348 { CODE_FOR_mmachs, "__MMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8349 { CODE_FOR_mmachu, "__MMACHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8350 { CODE_FOR_mmrdhs, "__MMRDHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8351 { CODE_FOR_mmrdhu, "__MMRDHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8352 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxrs, "__MQCPXRS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8353 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxru, "__MQCPXRU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8354 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxis, "__MQCPXIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8355 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxiu, "__MQCPXIU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8356 { CODE_FOR_mqmulhs, "__MQMULHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8357 { CODE_FOR_mqmulhu, "__MQMULHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8358 { CODE_FOR_mqmulxhs, "__MQMULXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8359 { CODE_FOR_mqmulxhu, "__MQMULXHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8360 { CODE_FOR_mqmachs, "__MQMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8361 { CODE_FOR_mqmachu, "__MQMACHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8362 { CODE_FOR_mqxmachs, "__MQXMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8363 { CODE_FOR_mqxmacxhs, "__MQXMACXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8364 { CODE_FOR_mqmacxhs, "__MQMACXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS, UNKNOWN, 0}
36a05131
BS
8365};
8366
8367/* Media intrinsics that take two accumulator numbers as argument and
8368 return void. */
8369
8370static struct builtin_description bdesc_voidacc[] =
8371{
5c5e8419
JR
8372 { CODE_FOR_maddaccs, "__MADDACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8373 { CODE_FOR_msubaccs, "__MSUBACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8374 { CODE_FOR_masaccs, "__MASACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8375 { CODE_FOR_mdaddaccs, "__MDADDACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8376 { CODE_FOR_mdsubaccs, "__MDSUBACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8377 { CODE_FOR_mdasaccs, "__MDASACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS, UNKNOWN, 0}
36a05131
BS
8378};
8379
38c28a25
AH
8380/* Intrinsics that load a value and then issue a MEMBAR. The load is
8381 a normal move and the ICODE is for the membar. */
c14ff86e
AH
8382
8383static struct builtin_description bdesc_loads[] =
8384{
38c28a25 8385 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi, "__builtin_read8",
5c5e8419 8386 FRV_BUILTIN_READ8, UNKNOWN, 0},
38c28a25 8387 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi, "__builtin_read16",
5c5e8419 8388 FRV_BUILTIN_READ16, UNKNOWN, 0},
38c28a25 8389 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si, "__builtin_read32",
5c5e8419 8390 FRV_BUILTIN_READ32, UNKNOWN, 0},
38c28a25 8391 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di, "__builtin_read64",
5c5e8419 8392 FRV_BUILTIN_READ64, UNKNOWN, 0}
c14ff86e
AH
8393};
8394
8395/* Likewise stores. */
8396
8397static struct builtin_description bdesc_stores[] =
8398{
38c28a25 8399 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi, "__builtin_write8",
5c5e8419 8400 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE8, UNKNOWN, 0},
38c28a25 8401 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi, "__builtin_write16",
5c5e8419 8402 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE16, UNKNOWN, 0},
38c28a25 8403 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si, "__builtin_write32",
5c5e8419 8404 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE32, UNKNOWN, 0},
38c28a25 8405 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di, "__builtin_write64",
5c5e8419 8406 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE64, UNKNOWN, 0},
c14ff86e
AH
8407};
8408
87b483a1 8409/* Initialize media builtins. */
36a05131 8410
14966b94 8411static void
f2206911 8412frv_init_builtins (void)
36a05131 8413{
36a05131
BS
8414 tree accumulator = integer_type_node;
8415 tree integer = integer_type_node;
8416 tree voidt = void_type_node;
8417 tree uhalf = short_unsigned_type_node;
8418 tree sword1 = long_integer_type_node;
8419 tree uword1 = long_unsigned_type_node;
8420 tree sword2 = long_long_integer_type_node;
8421 tree uword2 = long_long_unsigned_type_node;
8422 tree uword4 = build_pointer_type (uword1);
c14ff86e
AH
8423 tree vptr = build_pointer_type (build_type_variant (void_type_node, 0, 1));
8424 tree ubyte = unsigned_char_type_node;
c557edf4 8425 tree iacc = integer_type_node;
36a05131
BS
8426
8427#define UNARY(RET, T1) \
e84a6fcf 8428 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, NULL_TREE)
36a05131
BS
8429
8430#define BINARY(RET, T1, T2) \
e84a6fcf 8431 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, NULL_TREE)
36a05131
BS
8432
8433#define TRINARY(RET, T1, T2, T3) \
e84a6fcf 8434 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, T3, NULL_TREE)
36a05131 8435
a738d848 8436#define QUAD(RET, T1, T2, T3, T4) \
e84a6fcf 8437 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, T3, NULL_TREE)
a738d848 8438
e84a6fcf 8439 tree void_ftype_void = build_function_type_list (voidt, NULL_TREE);
36a05131
BS
8440
8441 tree void_ftype_acc = UNARY (voidt, accumulator);
8442 tree void_ftype_uw4_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, uword4, uword1);
8443 tree void_ftype_uw4_uw2 = BINARY (voidt, uword4, uword2);
8444 tree void_ftype_acc_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword1);
8445 tree void_ftype_acc_acc = BINARY (voidt, accumulator, accumulator);
8446 tree void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword1, uword1);
8447 tree void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, sword1, sword1);
8448 tree void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword2, uword2);
8449 tree void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, sword2, sword2);
8450
8451 tree uw1_ftype_uw1 = UNARY (uword1, uword1);
8452 tree uw1_ftype_sw1 = UNARY (uword1, sword1);
8453 tree uw1_ftype_uw2 = UNARY (uword1, uword2);
8454 tree uw1_ftype_acc = UNARY (uword1, accumulator);
8455 tree uw1_ftype_uh_uh = BINARY (uword1, uhalf, uhalf);
8456 tree uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, uword1, uword1);
8457 tree uw1_ftype_uw1_int = BINARY (uword1, uword1, integer);
8458 tree uw1_ftype_acc_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, accumulator, uword1);
8459 tree uw1_ftype_acc_sw1 = BINARY (uword1, accumulator, sword1);
8460 tree uw1_ftype_uw2_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, uword2, uword1);
8461 tree uw1_ftype_uw2_int = BINARY (uword1, uword2, integer);
8462
8463 tree sw1_ftype_int = UNARY (sword1, integer);
8464 tree sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (sword1, sword1, sword1);
8465 tree sw1_ftype_sw1_int = BINARY (sword1, sword1, integer);
8466
8467 tree uw2_ftype_uw1 = UNARY (uword2, uword1);
8468 tree uw2_ftype_uw1_int = BINARY (uword2, uword1, integer);
8469 tree uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2 = BINARY (uword2, uword2, uword2);
8470 tree uw2_ftype_uw2_int = BINARY (uword2, uword2, integer);
8471 tree uw2_ftype_acc_int = BINARY (uword2, accumulator, integer);
a738d848 8472 tree uw2_ftype_uh_uh_uh_uh = QUAD (uword2, uhalf, uhalf, uhalf, uhalf);
36a05131
BS
8473
8474 tree sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2 = BINARY (sword2, sword2, sword2);
c557edf4
RS
8475 tree sw2_ftype_sw2_int = BINARY (sword2, sword2, integer);
8476 tree uw2_ftype_uw1_uw1 = BINARY (uword2, uword1, uword1);
8477 tree sw2_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (sword2, sword1, sword1);
8478 tree void_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (voidt, sword1, sword1);
8479 tree void_ftype_iacc_sw2 = BINARY (voidt, iacc, sword2);
8480 tree void_ftype_iacc_sw1 = BINARY (voidt, iacc, sword1);
8481 tree sw1_ftype_sw1 = UNARY (sword1, sword1);
8482 tree sw2_ftype_iacc = UNARY (sword2, iacc);
8483 tree sw1_ftype_iacc = UNARY (sword1, iacc);
8484 tree void_ftype_ptr = UNARY (voidt, const_ptr_type_node);
c14ff86e
AH
8485 tree uw1_ftype_vptr = UNARY (uword1, vptr);
8486 tree uw2_ftype_vptr = UNARY (uword2, vptr);
8487 tree void_ftype_vptr_ub = BINARY (voidt, vptr, ubyte);
8488 tree void_ftype_vptr_uh = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uhalf);
8489 tree void_ftype_vptr_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uword1);
8490 tree void_ftype_vptr_uw2 = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uword2);
36a05131
BS
8491
8492 def_builtin ("__MAND", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MAND);
8493 def_builtin ("__MOR", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MOR);
8494 def_builtin ("__MXOR", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MXOR);
8495 def_builtin ("__MNOT", uw1_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MNOT);
8496 def_builtin ("__MROTLI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MROTLI);
8497 def_builtin ("__MROTRI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MROTRI);
8498 def_builtin ("__MWCUT", uw1_ftype_uw2_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWCUT);
8499 def_builtin ("__MAVEH", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MAVEH);
8500 def_builtin ("__MSLLHI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSLLHI);
8501 def_builtin ("__MSRLHI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSRLHI);
8502 def_builtin ("__MSRAHI", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSRAHI);
8503 def_builtin ("__MSATHS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHS);
8504 def_builtin ("__MSATHU", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHU);
8505 def_builtin ("__MADDHSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHSS);
8506 def_builtin ("__MADDHUS", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHUS);
8507 def_builtin ("__MSUBHSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHSS);
8508 def_builtin ("__MSUBHUS", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHUS);
8509 def_builtin ("__MMULHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHS);
8510 def_builtin ("__MMULHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHU);
8511 def_builtin ("__MMULXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHS);
8512 def_builtin ("__MMULXHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHU);
8513 def_builtin ("__MMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHS);
8514 def_builtin ("__MMACHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHU);
8515 def_builtin ("__MMRDHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHS);
8516 def_builtin ("__MMRDHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHU);
8517 def_builtin ("__MQADDHSS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHSS);
8518 def_builtin ("__MQADDHUS", uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHUS);
8519 def_builtin ("__MQSUBHSS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHSS);
8520 def_builtin ("__MQSUBHUS", uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHUS);
8521 def_builtin ("__MQMULHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHS);
8522 def_builtin ("__MQMULHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHU);
8523 def_builtin ("__MQMULXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHS);
8524 def_builtin ("__MQMULXHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHU);
8525 def_builtin ("__MQMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHS);
8526 def_builtin ("__MQMACHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHU);
8527 def_builtin ("__MCPXRS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRS);
8528 def_builtin ("__MCPXRU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRU);
8529 def_builtin ("__MCPXIS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIS);
8530 def_builtin ("__MCPXIU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIU);
8531 def_builtin ("__MQCPXRS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRS);
8532 def_builtin ("__MQCPXRU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRU);
8533 def_builtin ("__MQCPXIS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIS);
8534 def_builtin ("__MQCPXIU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIU);
8535 def_builtin ("__MCUT", uw1_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCUT);
8536 def_builtin ("__MCUTSS", uw1_ftype_acc_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCUTSS);
8537 def_builtin ("__MEXPDHW", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHW);
8538 def_builtin ("__MEXPDHD", uw2_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHD);
8539 def_builtin ("__MPACKH", uw1_ftype_uh_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_MPACKH);
8540 def_builtin ("__MUNPACKH", uw2_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MUNPACKH);
a738d848 8541 def_builtin ("__MDPACKH", uw2_ftype_uh_uh_uh_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_MDPACKH);
b16c1435 8542 def_builtin ("__MDUNPACKH", void_ftype_uw4_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH);
36a05131
BS
8543 def_builtin ("__MBTOH", uw2_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOH);
8544 def_builtin ("__MHTOB", uw1_ftype_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MHTOB);
8545 def_builtin ("__MBTOHE", void_ftype_uw4_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE);
8546 def_builtin ("__MCLRACC", void_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACC);
8547 def_builtin ("__MCLRACCA", void_ftype_void, FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACCA);
8548 def_builtin ("__MRDACC", uw1_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACC);
8549 def_builtin ("__MRDACCG", uw1_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACCG);
8550 def_builtin ("__MWTACC", void_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACC);
8551 def_builtin ("__MWTACCG", void_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACCG);
8552 def_builtin ("__Mcop1", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1);
8553 def_builtin ("__Mcop2", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2);
8554 def_builtin ("__MTRAP", void_ftype_void, FRV_BUILTIN_MTRAP);
8555 def_builtin ("__MQXMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS);
8556 def_builtin ("__MQXMACXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS);
8557 def_builtin ("__MQMACXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS);
8558 def_builtin ("__MADDACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS);
8559 def_builtin ("__MSUBACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS);
8560 def_builtin ("__MASACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS);
8561 def_builtin ("__MDADDACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS);
8562 def_builtin ("__MDSUBACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS);
8563 def_builtin ("__MDASACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS);
8564 def_builtin ("__MABSHS", uw1_ftype_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS);
8565 def_builtin ("__MDROTLI", uw2_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI);
8566 def_builtin ("__MCPLHI", uw1_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI);
8567 def_builtin ("__MCPLI", uw1_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI);
8568 def_builtin ("__MDCUTSSI", uw2_ftype_acc_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI);
8569 def_builtin ("__MQSATHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS);
8570 def_builtin ("__MHSETLOS", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS);
8571 def_builtin ("__MHSETHIS", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS);
8572 def_builtin ("__MHDSETS", sw1_ftype_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS);
8573 def_builtin ("__MHSETLOH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH);
8574 def_builtin ("__MHSETHIH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH);
8575 def_builtin ("__MHDSETH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH);
c557edf4
RS
8576 def_builtin ("__MQLCLRHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS);
8577 def_builtin ("__MQLMTHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS);
8578 def_builtin ("__MQSLLHI", uw2_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI);
8579 def_builtin ("__MQSRAHI", sw2_ftype_sw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI);
8580 def_builtin ("__SMUL", sw2_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMUL);
8581 def_builtin ("__UMUL", uw2_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_UMUL);
8582 def_builtin ("__SMASS", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS);
8583 def_builtin ("__SMSSS", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS);
8584 def_builtin ("__SMU", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMU);
8585 def_builtin ("__ADDSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS);
8586 def_builtin ("__SUBSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS);
8587 def_builtin ("__SLASS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS);
8588 def_builtin ("__SCAN", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SCAN);
8589 def_builtin ("__SCUTSS", sw1_ftype_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS);
8590 def_builtin ("__IACCreadll", sw2_ftype_iacc, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll);
8591 def_builtin ("__IACCreadl", sw1_ftype_iacc, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl);
8592 def_builtin ("__IACCsetll", void_ftype_iacc_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll);
8593 def_builtin ("__IACCsetl", void_ftype_iacc_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl);
8594 def_builtin ("__data_prefetch0", void_ftype_ptr, FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH0);
8595 def_builtin ("__data_prefetch", void_ftype_ptr, FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH);
c14ff86e
AH
8596 def_builtin ("__builtin_read8", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ8);
8597 def_builtin ("__builtin_read16", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ16);
8598 def_builtin ("__builtin_read32", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ32);
8599 def_builtin ("__builtin_read64", uw2_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ64);
8600
8601 def_builtin ("__builtin_write8", void_ftype_vptr_ub, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE8);
8602 def_builtin ("__builtin_write16", void_ftype_vptr_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE16);
8603 def_builtin ("__builtin_write32", void_ftype_vptr_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE32);
8604 def_builtin ("__builtin_write64", void_ftype_vptr_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE64);
36a05131
BS
8605
8606#undef UNARY
8607#undef BINARY
8608#undef TRINARY
a738d848 8609#undef QUAD
36a05131
BS
8610}
8611
c15c90bb
ZW
8612/* Set the names for various arithmetic operations according to the
8613 FRV ABI. */
8614static void
8615frv_init_libfuncs (void)
8616{
8617 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, SImode, "__modi");
8618 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, SImode, "__umodi");
8619
8620 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DImode, "__addll");
8621 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DImode, "__subll");
8622 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DImode, "__mulll");
8623 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DImode, "__divll");
8624 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, DImode, "__modll");
8625 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, DImode, "__umodll");
8626 set_optab_libfunc (and_optab, DImode, "__andll");
8627 set_optab_libfunc (ior_optab, DImode, "__orll");
8628 set_optab_libfunc (xor_optab, DImode, "__xorll");
8629 set_optab_libfunc (one_cmpl_optab, DImode, "__notll");
8630
8631 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, SFmode, "__addf");
8632 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, SFmode, "__subf");
8633 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, SFmode, "__mulf");
8634 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SFmode, "__divf");
8635
8636 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DFmode, "__addd");
8637 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DFmode, "__subd");
8638 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DFmode, "__muld");
8639 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DFmode, "__divd");
8640
85363ca0
ZW
8641 set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, DFmode, SFmode, "__ftod");
8642 set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, SFmode, DFmode, "__dtof");
8643
8644 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__ftoi");
8645 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__ftoll");
8646 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__dtoi");
8647 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__dtoll");
8648
8649 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__ftoui");
09c55720
RS
8650 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__ftoull");
8651 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__dtoui");
8652 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__dtoull");
85363ca0
ZW
8653
8654 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, SImode, "__itof");
8655 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, DImode, "__lltof");
8656 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, SImode, "__itod");
8657 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, DImode, "__lltod");
c15c90bb
ZW
8658}
8659
36a05131
BS
8660/* Convert an integer constant to an accumulator register. ICODE is the
8661 code of the target instruction, OPNUM is the number of the
8662 accumulator operand and OPVAL is the constant integer. Try both
8663 ACC and ACCG registers; only report an error if neither fit the
8664 instruction. */
8665
8666static rtx
f2206911 8667frv_int_to_acc (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx opval)
36a05131
BS
8668{
8669 rtx reg;
c557edf4
RS
8670 int i;
8671
0fa2e4df 8672 /* ACCs and ACCGs are implicit global registers if media intrinsics
c557edf4 8673 are being used. We set up this lazily to avoid creating lots of
c112cf2b 8674 unnecessary call_insn rtl in non-media code. */
c557edf4
RS
8675 for (i = 0; i <= ACC_MASK; i++)
8676 if ((i & ACC_MASK) == i)
8677 global_regs[i + ACC_FIRST] = global_regs[i + ACCG_FIRST] = 1;
36a05131
BS
8678
8679 if (GET_CODE (opval) != CONST_INT)
8680 {
8681 error ("accumulator is not a constant integer");
8682 return NULL_RTX;
8683 }
c557edf4 8684 if ((INTVAL (opval) & ~ACC_MASK) != 0)
36a05131
BS
8685 {
8686 error ("accumulator number is out of bounds");
8687 return NULL_RTX;
8688 }
8689
8690 reg = gen_rtx_REG (insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].mode,
8691 ACC_FIRST + INTVAL (opval));
8692 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (reg, VOIDmode))
6fb5fa3c 8693 SET_REGNO (reg, ACCG_FIRST + INTVAL (opval));
36a05131
BS
8694
8695 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (reg, VOIDmode))
8696 {
9e637a26 8697 error ("inappropriate accumulator for %qs", insn_data[icode].name);
36a05131
BS
8698 return NULL_RTX;
8699 }
8700 return reg;
8701}
8702
8703/* If an ACC rtx has mode MODE, return the mode that the matching ACCG
8704 should have. */
8705
8706static enum machine_mode
f2206911 8707frv_matching_accg_mode (enum machine_mode mode)
36a05131
BS
8708{
8709 switch (mode)
8710 {
8711 case V4SImode:
8712 return V4QImode;
8713
8714 case DImode:
8715 return HImode;
8716
8717 case SImode:
8718 return QImode;
8719
8720 default:
44e91694 8721 gcc_unreachable ();
36a05131
BS
8722 }
8723}
8724
38c28a25
AH
8725/* Given that a __builtin_read or __builtin_write function is accessing
8726 address ADDRESS, return the value that should be used as operand 1
8727 of the membar. */
8728
8729static rtx
8730frv_io_address_cookie (rtx address)
8731{
8732 return (GET_CODE (address) == CONST_INT
8733 ? GEN_INT (INTVAL (address) / 8 * 8)
8734 : const0_rtx);
8735}
8736
36a05131
BS
8737/* Return the accumulator guard that should be paired with accumulator
8738 register ACC. The mode of the returned register is in the same
8739 class as ACC, but is four times smaller. */
8740
8741rtx
f2206911 8742frv_matching_accg_for_acc (rtx acc)
36a05131
BS
8743{
8744 return gen_rtx_REG (frv_matching_accg_mode (GET_MODE (acc)),
8745 REGNO (acc) - ACC_FIRST + ACCG_FIRST);
8746}
8747
2396bce1
EC
8748/* Read the requested argument from the call EXP given by INDEX.
8749 Return the value as an rtx. */
36a05131
BS
8750
8751static rtx
2396bce1 8752frv_read_argument (tree exp, unsigned int index)
36a05131 8753{
5c5e8419 8754 return expand_normal (CALL_EXPR_ARG (exp, index));
36a05131
BS
8755}
8756
c557edf4
RS
8757/* Like frv_read_argument, but interpret the argument as the number
8758 of an IACC register and return a (reg:MODE ...) rtx for it. */
8759
8760static rtx
2396bce1
EC
8761frv_read_iacc_argument (enum machine_mode mode, tree call,
8762 unsigned int index)
c557edf4
RS
8763{
8764 int i, regno;
8765 rtx op;
8766
2396bce1 8767 op = frv_read_argument (call, index);
c557edf4
RS
8768 if (GET_CODE (op) != CONST_INT
8769 || INTVAL (op) < 0
8770 || INTVAL (op) > IACC_LAST - IACC_FIRST
8771 || ((INTVAL (op) * 4) & (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1)) != 0)
8772 {
8773 error ("invalid IACC argument");
8774 op = const0_rtx;
8775 }
8776
0fa2e4df 8777 /* IACCs are implicit global registers. We set up this lazily to
c112cf2b 8778 avoid creating lots of unnecessary call_insn rtl when IACCs aren't
c557edf4
RS
8779 being used. */
8780 regno = INTVAL (op) + IACC_FIRST;
8781 for (i = 0; i < HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode); i++)
8782 global_regs[regno + i] = 1;
8783
8784 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
8785}
8786
36a05131
BS
8787/* Return true if OPVAL can be used for operand OPNUM of instruction ICODE.
8788 The instruction should require a constant operand of some sort. The
8789 function prints an error if OPVAL is not valid. */
8790
8791static int
f2206911 8792frv_check_constant_argument (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx opval)
36a05131
BS
8793{
8794 if (GET_CODE (opval) != CONST_INT)
8795 {
9e637a26 8796 error ("%qs expects a constant argument", insn_data[icode].name);
36a05131
BS
8797 return FALSE;
8798 }
8799 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (opval, VOIDmode))
8800 {
9e637a26 8801 error ("constant argument out of range for %qs", insn_data[icode].name);
36a05131
BS
8802 return FALSE;
8803 }
8804 return TRUE;
8805}
8806
8807/* Return a legitimate rtx for instruction ICODE's return value. Use TARGET
8808 if it's not null, has the right mode, and satisfies operand 0's
8809 predicate. */
8810
8811static rtx
f2206911 8812frv_legitimize_target (enum insn_code icode, rtx target)
36a05131
BS
8813{
8814 enum machine_mode mode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
8815
8816 if (! target
8817 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8818 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, mode))
8819 return gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8820 else
8821 return target;
8822}
8823
8824/* Given that ARG is being passed as operand OPNUM to instruction ICODE,
839a4992 8825 check whether ARG satisfies the operand's constraints. If it doesn't,
36a05131
BS
8826 copy ARG to a temporary register and return that. Otherwise return ARG
8827 itself. */
8828
8829static rtx
f2206911 8830frv_legitimize_argument (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx arg)
36a05131
BS
8831{
8832 enum machine_mode mode = insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].mode;
8833
8834 if ((*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (arg, mode))
8835 return arg;
8836 else
8837 return copy_to_mode_reg (mode, arg);
8838}
8839
c14ff86e
AH
8840/* Return a volatile memory reference of mode MODE whose address is ARG. */
8841
8842static rtx
8843frv_volatile_memref (enum machine_mode mode, rtx arg)
8844{
8845 rtx mem;
8846
8847 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, memory_address (mode, arg));
8848 MEM_VOLATILE_P (mem) = 1;
8849 return mem;
8850}
8851
36a05131
BS
8852/* Expand builtins that take a single, constant argument. At the moment,
8853 only MHDSETS falls into this category. */
8854
8855static rtx
2396bce1 8856frv_expand_set_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
36a05131
BS
8857{
8858 rtx pat;
2396bce1 8859 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
36a05131
BS
8860
8861 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 1, op0))
8862 return NULL_RTX;
8863
8864 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8865 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8866 if (! pat)
8867 return NULL_RTX;
8868
8869 emit_insn (pat);
8870 return target;
8871}
8872
87b483a1 8873/* Expand builtins that take one operand. */
36a05131
BS
8874
8875static rtx
2396bce1 8876frv_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
36a05131
BS
8877{
8878 rtx pat;
2396bce1 8879 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
36a05131
BS
8880
8881 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8882 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8883 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8884 if (! pat)
8885 return NULL_RTX;
8886
8887 emit_insn (pat);
8888 return target;
8889}
8890
87b483a1 8891/* Expand builtins that take two operands. */
36a05131
BS
8892
8893static rtx
2396bce1 8894frv_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
36a05131
BS
8895{
8896 rtx pat;
2396bce1
EC
8897 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8898 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
36a05131
BS
8899
8900 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8901 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8902 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op1);
8903 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8904 if (! pat)
8905 return NULL_RTX;
8906
8907 emit_insn (pat);
8908 return target;
8909}
8910
8911/* Expand cut-style builtins, which take two operands and an implicit ACCG
87b483a1 8912 one. */
36a05131
BS
8913
8914static rtx
2396bce1 8915frv_expand_cut_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
36a05131
BS
8916{
8917 rtx pat;
2396bce1
EC
8918 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8919 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
36a05131
BS
8920 rtx op2;
8921
8922 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8923 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op0);
8924 if (! op0)
8925 return NULL_RTX;
8926
8927 if (icode == CODE_FOR_mdcutssi || GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
8928 {
8929 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 2, op1))
8930 return NULL_RTX;
8931 }
8932 else
8933 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op1);
8934
8935 op2 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
8936 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1, op2);
8937 if (! pat)
8938 return NULL_RTX;
8939
8940 emit_insn (pat);
8941 return target;
8942}
8943
87b483a1 8944/* Expand builtins that take two operands and the second is immediate. */
36a05131
BS
8945
8946static rtx
2396bce1 8947frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
36a05131
BS
8948{
8949 rtx pat;
2396bce1
EC
8950 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8951 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
36a05131
BS
8952
8953 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 2, op1))
8954 return NULL_RTX;
8955
8956 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8957 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8958 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8959 if (! pat)
8960 return NULL_RTX;
8961
8962 emit_insn (pat);
8963 return target;
8964}
8965
8966/* Expand builtins that take two operands, the first operand being a pointer to
87b483a1 8967 ints and return void. */
36a05131
BS
8968
8969static rtx
2396bce1 8970frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
36a05131
BS
8971{
8972 rtx pat;
2396bce1
EC
8973 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8974 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
36a05131
BS
8975 enum machine_mode mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
8976 rtx addr;
8977
8978 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
8979 {
8980 rtx reg = op0;
8981
8982 if (! offsettable_address_p (0, mode0, op0))
8983 {
8984 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
8985 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, op0));
8986 }
8987
8988 op0 = gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, reg);
8989 }
8990
8991 addr = XEXP (op0, 0);
8992 if (! offsettable_address_p (0, mode0, addr))
8993 addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, op0);
8994
8995 op0 = change_address (op0, V4SImode, addr);
8996 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
8997 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
8998 if (! pat)
8999 return 0;
9000
9001 emit_insn (pat);
9002 return 0;
9003}
9004
c557edf4
RS
9005/* Expand builtins that take two long operands and return void. */
9006
9007static rtx
2396bce1 9008frv_expand_int_void2arg (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
c557edf4
RS
9009{
9010 rtx pat;
2396bce1
EC
9011 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9012 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
c557edf4
RS
9013
9014 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
9015 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9016 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
9017 if (! pat)
9018 return NULL_RTX;
9019
9020 emit_insn (pat);
9021 return NULL_RTX;
9022}
9023
9024/* Expand prefetch builtins. These take a single address as argument. */
9025
9026static rtx
2396bce1 9027frv_expand_prefetches (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
c557edf4
RS
9028{
9029 rtx pat;
2396bce1 9030 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
c557edf4
RS
9031
9032 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (force_reg (Pmode, op0));
9033 if (! pat)
9034 return 0;
9035
9036 emit_insn (pat);
9037 return 0;
9038}
9039
36a05131
BS
9040/* Expand builtins that take three operands and return void. The first
9041 argument must be a constant that describes a pair or quad accumulators. A
9042 fourth argument is created that is the accumulator guard register that
9043 corresponds to the accumulator. */
9044
9045static rtx
2396bce1 9046frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
36a05131
BS
9047{
9048 rtx pat;
2396bce1
EC
9049 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9050 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9051 rtx op2 = frv_read_argument (call, 2);
36a05131
BS
9052 rtx op3;
9053
9054 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9055 if (! op0)
9056 return NULL_RTX;
9057
9058 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9059 op2 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op2);
9060 op3 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
9061 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1, op2, op3);
9062 if (! pat)
9063 return NULL_RTX;
9064
9065 emit_insn (pat);
9066 return NULL_RTX;
9067}
9068
9069/* Expand builtins that perform accumulator-to-accumulator operations.
9070 These builtins take two accumulator numbers as argument and return
9071 void. */
9072
9073static rtx
2396bce1 9074frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
36a05131
BS
9075{
9076 rtx pat;
2396bce1
EC
9077 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9078 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
36a05131
BS
9079 rtx op2;
9080 rtx op3;
9081
9082 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9083 if (! op0)
9084 return NULL_RTX;
9085
9086 op1 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op1);
9087 if (! op1)
9088 return NULL_RTX;
9089
9090 op2 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
9091 op3 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op1);
9092 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1, op2, op3);
9093 if (! pat)
9094 return NULL_RTX;
9095
9096 emit_insn (pat);
9097 return NULL_RTX;
9098}
9099
38c28a25
AH
9100/* Expand a __builtin_read* function. ICODE is the instruction code for the
9101 membar and TARGET_MODE is the mode that the loaded value should have. */
c14ff86e
AH
9102
9103static rtx
38c28a25 9104frv_expand_load_builtin (enum insn_code icode, enum machine_mode target_mode,
2396bce1 9105 tree call, rtx target)
c14ff86e 9106{
2396bce1 9107 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
38c28a25
AH
9108 rtx cookie = frv_io_address_cookie (op0);
9109
9110 if (target == 0 || !REG_P (target))
9111 target = gen_reg_rtx (target_mode);
9112 op0 = frv_volatile_memref (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op0);
9113 convert_move (target, op0, 1);
9114 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (copy_rtx (op0), cookie, GEN_INT (FRV_IO_READ)));
9115 cfun->machine->has_membar_p = 1;
c14ff86e
AH
9116 return target;
9117}
9118
38c28a25 9119/* Likewise __builtin_write* functions. */
c14ff86e
AH
9120
9121static rtx
2396bce1 9122frv_expand_store_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
c14ff86e 9123{
2396bce1
EC
9124 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9125 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
38c28a25 9126 rtx cookie = frv_io_address_cookie (op0);
c14ff86e 9127
38c28a25
AH
9128 op0 = frv_volatile_memref (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op0);
9129 convert_move (op0, force_reg (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op1), 1);
9130 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (copy_rtx (op0), cookie, GEN_INT (FRV_IO_WRITE)));
9131 cfun->machine->has_membar_p = 1;
c14ff86e
AH
9132 return NULL_RTX;
9133}
9134
a738d848
RS
9135/* Expand the MDPACKH builtin. It takes four unsigned short arguments and
9136 each argument forms one word of the two double-word input registers.
2396bce1
EC
9137 CALL is the tree for the call and TARGET, if nonnull, suggests a good place
9138 to put the return value. */
a738d848
RS
9139
9140static rtx
2396bce1 9141frv_expand_mdpackh_builtin (tree call, rtx target)
a738d848
RS
9142{
9143 enum insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_mdpackh;
9144 rtx pat, op0, op1;
2396bce1
EC
9145 rtx arg1 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9146 rtx arg2 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9147 rtx arg3 = frv_read_argument (call, 2);
9148 rtx arg4 = frv_read_argument (call, 3);
a738d848
RS
9149
9150 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
9151 op0 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9152 op1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9153
0fa2e4df 9154 /* The high half of each word is not explicitly initialized, so indicate
a738d848 9155 that the input operands are not live before this point. */
c41c1387
RS
9156 emit_clobber (op0);
9157 emit_clobber (op1);
a738d848
RS
9158
9159 /* Move each argument into the low half of its associated input word. */
9160 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op0, DImode, 2), arg1);
9161 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op0, DImode, 6), arg2);
9162 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op1, DImode, 2), arg3);
9163 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op1, DImode, 6), arg4);
9164
9165 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
9166 if (! pat)
9167 return NULL_RTX;
9168
9169 emit_insn (pat);
9170 return target;
9171}
9172
36a05131
BS
9173/* Expand the MCLRACC builtin. This builtin takes a single accumulator
9174 number as argument. */
9175
9176static rtx
2396bce1 9177frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (tree call)
36a05131
BS
9178{
9179 enum insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_mclracc;
9180 rtx pat;
2396bce1 9181 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
36a05131
BS
9182
9183 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9184 if (! op0)
9185 return NULL_RTX;
9186
9187 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0);
9188 if (pat)
9189 emit_insn (pat);
9190
9191 return NULL_RTX;
9192}
9193
9194/* Expand builtins that take no arguments. */
9195
9196static rtx
f2206911 9197frv_expand_noargs_builtin (enum insn_code icode)
36a05131 9198{
a556fd39 9199 rtx pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (const0_rtx);
36a05131
BS
9200 if (pat)
9201 emit_insn (pat);
9202
9203 return NULL_RTX;
9204}
9205
9206/* Expand MRDACC and MRDACCG. These builtins take a single accumulator
9207 number or accumulator guard number as argument and return an SI integer. */
9208
9209static rtx
2396bce1 9210frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
36a05131
BS
9211{
9212 rtx pat;
9213 rtx target = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
2396bce1 9214 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
36a05131
BS
9215
9216 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op0);
9217 if (! op0)
9218 return NULL_RTX;
9219
9220 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
9221 if (! pat)
9222 return NULL_RTX;
9223
9224 emit_insn (pat);
9225 return target;
9226}
9227
9228/* Expand MWTACC and MWTACCG. These builtins take an accumulator or
9229 accumulator guard as their first argument and an SImode value as their
9230 second. */
9231
9232static rtx
2396bce1 9233frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
36a05131
BS
9234{
9235 rtx pat;
2396bce1
EC
9236 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9237 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
36a05131
BS
9238
9239 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9240 if (! op0)
9241 return NULL_RTX;
9242
9243 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9244 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
9245 if (pat)
9246 emit_insn (pat);
9247
9248 return NULL_RTX;
9249}
9250
c557edf4
RS
9251/* Emit a move from SRC to DEST in SImode chunks. This can be used
9252 to move DImode values into and out of IACC0. */
9253
9254static void
9255frv_split_iacc_move (rtx dest, rtx src)
9256{
9257 enum machine_mode inner;
9258 int i;
9259
9260 inner = GET_MODE (dest);
9261 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (inner); i += GET_MODE_SIZE (SImode))
9262 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (SImode, dest, inner, i),
9263 simplify_gen_subreg (SImode, src, inner, i));
9264}
9265
87b483a1 9266/* Expand builtins. */
36a05131 9267
14966b94 9268static rtx
f2206911
KC
9269frv_expand_builtin (tree exp,
9270 rtx target,
9271 rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9272 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9273 int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
36a05131 9274{
5039610b 9275 tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (CALL_EXPR_FN (exp), 0);
36a05131
BS
9276 unsigned fcode = (unsigned)DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
9277 unsigned i;
9278 struct builtin_description *d;
9279
c557edf4 9280 if (fcode < FRV_BUILTIN_FIRST_NONMEDIA && !TARGET_MEDIA)
36a05131
BS
9281 {
9282 error ("media functions are not available unless -mmedia is used");
9283 return NULL_RTX;
9284 }
9285
9286 switch (fcode)
9287 {
9288 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1:
9289 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2:
9290 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH:
9291 case FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE:
9292 if (! TARGET_MEDIA_REV1)
9293 {
9294 error ("this media function is only available on the fr500");
9295 return NULL_RTX;
9296 }
9297 break;
9298
9299 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS:
9300 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS:
9301 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS:
9302 case FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS:
9303 case FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS:
9304 case FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS:
9305 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS:
9306 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS:
9307 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS:
9308 case FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS:
9309 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI:
9310 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI:
9311 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI:
9312 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI:
9313 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS:
9314 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS:
9315 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH:
9316 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS:
9317 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH:
9318 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS:
9319 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH:
9320 if (! TARGET_MEDIA_REV2)
9321 {
c557edf4
RS
9322 error ("this media function is only available on the fr400"
9323 " and fr550");
9324 return NULL_RTX;
9325 }
9326 break;
9327
9328 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS:
9329 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS:
9330 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMU:
9331 case FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS:
9332 case FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS:
9333 case FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS:
9334 case FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS:
9335 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll:
9336 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl:
9337 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll:
9338 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl:
9339 if (!TARGET_FR405_BUILTINS)
9340 {
9341 error ("this builtin function is only available"
9342 " on the fr405 and fr450");
9343 return NULL_RTX;
9344 }
9345 break;
9346
9347 case FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH:
9348 if (!TARGET_FR500_FR550_BUILTINS)
9349 {
9350 error ("this builtin function is only available on the fr500"
9351 " and fr550");
9352 return NULL_RTX;
9353 }
9354 break;
9355
9356 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS:
9357 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS:
9358 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI:
9359 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI:
9360 if (!TARGET_MEDIA_FR450)
9361 {
9362 error ("this builtin function is only available on the fr450");
36a05131
BS
9363 return NULL_RTX;
9364 }
9365 break;
9366
9367 default:
9368 break;
9369 }
9370
87b483a1 9371 /* Expand unique builtins. */
36a05131
BS
9372
9373 switch (fcode)
9374 {
9375 case FRV_BUILTIN_MTRAP:
9376 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mtrap);
9377
9378 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACC:
2396bce1 9379 return frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (exp);
36a05131
BS
9380
9381 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACCA:
9382 if (TARGET_ACC_8)
9383 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mclracca8);
9384 else
9385 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mclracca4);
9386
9387 case FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACC:
2396bce1 9388 return frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mrdacc, exp);
36a05131
BS
9389
9390 case FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACCG:
2396bce1 9391 return frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mrdaccg, exp);
36a05131
BS
9392
9393 case FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACC:
2396bce1 9394 return frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mwtacc, exp);
36a05131
BS
9395
9396 case FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACCG:
2396bce1 9397 return frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mwtaccg, exp);
36a05131 9398
a738d848 9399 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDPACKH:
2396bce1 9400 return frv_expand_mdpackh_builtin (exp, target);
a738d848 9401
c557edf4
RS
9402 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll:
9403 {
2396bce1 9404 rtx src = frv_read_iacc_argument (DImode, exp, 0);
c557edf4
RS
9405 if (target == 0 || !REG_P (target))
9406 target = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9407 frv_split_iacc_move (target, src);
9408 return target;
9409 }
9410
9411 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl:
2396bce1 9412 return frv_read_iacc_argument (SImode, exp, 0);
c557edf4
RS
9413
9414 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll:
9415 {
2396bce1
EC
9416 rtx dest = frv_read_iacc_argument (DImode, exp, 0);
9417 rtx src = frv_read_argument (exp, 1);
c557edf4
RS
9418 frv_split_iacc_move (dest, force_reg (DImode, src));
9419 return 0;
9420 }
9421
9422 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl:
9423 {
2396bce1
EC
9424 rtx dest = frv_read_iacc_argument (SImode, exp, 0);
9425 rtx src = frv_read_argument (exp, 1);
c557edf4
RS
9426 emit_move_insn (dest, force_reg (SImode, src));
9427 return 0;
9428 }
9429
36a05131
BS
9430 default:
9431 break;
9432 }
9433
87b483a1 9434 /* Expand groups of builtins. */
36a05131 9435
e97a46ce 9436 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_set; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_set); i++, d++)
36a05131 9437 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9438 return frv_expand_set_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
36a05131 9439
e97a46ce 9440 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_1arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_1arg); i++, d++)
36a05131 9441 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9442 return frv_expand_unop_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
36a05131 9443
e97a46ce 9444 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2arg); i++, d++)
36a05131 9445 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9446 return frv_expand_binop_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
36a05131 9447
e97a46ce 9448 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_cut; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_cut); i++, d++)
36a05131 9449 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9450 return frv_expand_cut_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
36a05131 9451
e97a46ce
KG
9452 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2argimm; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2argimm); i++, d++)
9453 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9454 return frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
36a05131 9455
e97a46ce
KG
9456 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_void2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_void2arg); i++, d++)
9457 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9458 return frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
36a05131 9459
e97a46ce
KG
9460 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_void3arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_void3arg); i++, d++)
9461 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9462 return frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
e97a46ce
KG
9463
9464 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_voidacc; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_voidacc); i++, d++)
9465 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9466 return frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
36a05131 9467
c557edf4
RS
9468 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_int_void2arg;
9469 i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_int_void2arg); i++, d++)
9470 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9471 return frv_expand_int_void2arg (d->icode, exp);
c557edf4
RS
9472
9473 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_prefetches;
9474 i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_prefetches); i++, d++)
9475 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9476 return frv_expand_prefetches (d->icode, exp);
c557edf4 9477
c14ff86e
AH
9478 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_loads; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_loads); i++, d++)
9479 if (d->code == fcode)
38c28a25 9480 return frv_expand_load_builtin (d->icode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
2396bce1 9481 exp, target);
c14ff86e
AH
9482
9483 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_stores; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_stores); i++, d++)
9484 if (d->code == fcode)
2396bce1 9485 return frv_expand_store_builtin (d->icode, exp);
c14ff86e 9486
36a05131
BS
9487 return 0;
9488}
14966b94 9489
b3fbfc07 9490static bool
3101faab 9491frv_in_small_data_p (const_tree decl)
b3fbfc07 9492{
0f6e5d45 9493 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
3101faab 9494 const_tree section_name;
0f6e5d45
RH
9495
9496 /* Don't apply the -G flag to internal compiler structures. We
9497 should leave such structures in the main data section, partly
9498 for efficiency and partly because the size of some of them
9499 (such as C++ typeinfos) is not known until later. */
9500 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
9501 return false;
9502
0f6e5d45
RH
9503 /* If we already know which section the decl should be in, see if
9504 it's a small data section. */
9505 section_name = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
9506 if (section_name)
9507 {
44e91694 9508 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (section_name) == STRING_CST);
0f6e5d45
RH
9509 if (frv_string_begins_with (section_name, ".sdata"))
9510 return true;
9511 if (frv_string_begins_with (section_name, ".sbss"))
9512 return true;
68c0ab4f 9513 return false;
0f6e5d45 9514 }
b3fbfc07 9515
68c0ab4f 9516 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
fa37ed29 9517 if (size > 0 && size <= g_switch_value)
68c0ab4f
RS
9518 return true;
9519
0f6e5d45 9520 return false;
b3fbfc07 9521}
3c50106f
RH
9522\f
9523static bool
f2206911
KC
9524frv_rtx_costs (rtx x,
9525 int code ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9526 int outer_code ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
68f932c4 9527 int opno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
f40751dd
JH
9528 int *total,
9529 bool speed ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3c50106f 9530{
34208acf
AO
9531 if (outer_code == MEM)
9532 {
9533 /* Don't differentiate between memory addresses. All the ones
9534 we accept have equal cost. */
9535 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (0);
9536 return true;
9537 }
9538
3c50106f
RH
9539 switch (code)
9540 {
9541 case CONST_INT:
2300b9dd 9542 /* Make 12-bit integers really cheap. */
2f5b1308 9543 if (IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x), -2048, 2047))
3c50106f
RH
9544 {
9545 *total = 0;
9546 return true;
9547 }
87b483a1 9548 /* Fall through. */
3c50106f
RH
9549
9550 case CONST:
9551 case LABEL_REF:
9552 case SYMBOL_REF:
9553 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9554 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9555 return true;
9556
9557 case PLUS:
9558 case MINUS:
9559 case AND:
9560 case IOR:
9561 case XOR:
9562 case ASHIFT:
9563 case ASHIFTRT:
9564 case LSHIFTRT:
9565 case NOT:
9566 case NEG:
9567 case COMPARE:
9568 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode)
9569 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
9570 else if (GET_MODE (x) == DImode)
9571 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9572 else
9573 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
9574 return true;
9575
9576 case MULT:
9577 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode)
9578 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9579 else
9580 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6); /* guess */
9581 return true;
9582
9583 case DIV:
9584 case UDIV:
9585 case MOD:
9586 case UMOD:
9587 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (18);
9588 return true;
9589
34208acf
AO
9590 case MEM:
9591 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
9592 return true;
9593
3c50106f
RH
9594 default:
9595 return false;
9596 }
9597}
90a63880
RH
9598\f
9599static void
f2206911 9600frv_asm_out_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
90a63880 9601{
d6b5193b 9602 switch_to_section (ctors_section);
90a63880 9603 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
34208acf
AO
9604 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
9605 {
44e91694
NS
9606 int ok = frv_assemble_integer (symbol, POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
9607
9608 gcc_assert (ok);
34208acf
AO
9609 return;
9610 }
90a63880
RH
9611 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", symbol);
9612}
9613
9614static void
f2206911 9615frv_asm_out_destructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
90a63880 9616{
d6b5193b 9617 switch_to_section (dtors_section);
90a63880 9618 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
34208acf
AO
9619 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
9620 {
44e91694 9621 int ok = frv_assemble_integer (symbol, POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
2396bce1 9622
44e91694 9623 gcc_assert (ok);
34208acf
AO
9624 return;
9625 }
90a63880
RH
9626 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", symbol);
9627}
8ac411c7
KH
9628
9629/* Worker function for TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX. */
9630
9631static rtx
9632frv_struct_value_rtx (tree fntype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9633 int incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9634{
9635 return gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM);
9636}
c557edf4 9637
bef8809e
AH
9638#define TLS_BIAS (2048 - 16)
9639
fdbe66f2 9640/* This is called from dwarf2out.c via TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL.
bef8809e
AH
9641 We need to emit DTP-relative relocations. */
9642
fdbe66f2 9643static void
bef8809e
AH
9644frv_output_dwarf_dtprel (FILE *file, int size, rtx x)
9645{
44e91694 9646 gcc_assert (size == 4);
bef8809e
AH
9647 fputs ("\t.picptr\ttlsmoff(", file);
9648 /* We want the unbiased TLS offset, so add the bias to the
9649 expression, such that the implicit biasing cancels out. */
9650 output_addr_const (file, plus_constant (x, TLS_BIAS));
9651 fputs (")", file);
9652}
9653
c557edf4 9654#include "gt-frv.h"